WO2007110449A1 - Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use - Google Patents

Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2007110449A1
WO2007110449A1 PCT/EP2007/053053 EP2007053053W WO2007110449A1 WO 2007110449 A1 WO2007110449 A1 WO 2007110449A1 EP 2007053053 W EP2007053053 W EP 2007053053W WO 2007110449 A1 WO2007110449 A1 WO 2007110449A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
optionally substituted
alkyl
group
independently selected
haloalkyl
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/EP2007/053053
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Zhengming Chen
Khondaker Islam
Bin Shao
Jiangchao Yao
Xiaoming Zhou
Donald J. Kyle
Original Assignee
Euro-Celtique S.A.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Euro-Celtique S.A. filed Critical Euro-Celtique S.A.
Priority to US12/225,743 priority Critical patent/US8247442B2/en
Publication of WO2007110449A1 publication Critical patent/WO2007110449A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D211/00Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings
    • C07D211/04Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D211/06Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D211/36Heterocyclic compounds containing hydrogenated pyridine rings, not condensed with other rings with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D211/40Oxygen atoms
    • C07D211/42Oxygen atoms attached in position 3 or 5
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/06Antimigraine agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/08Antiepileptics; Anticonvulsants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/18Antipsychotics, i.e. neuroleptics; Drugs for mania or schizophrenia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/22Anxiolytics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/24Antidepressants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/06Antiarrhythmics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/12Antihypertensives
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D207/00Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D207/02Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D207/04Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D207/10Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D207/14Nitrogen atoms not forming part of a nitro radical
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D401/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links

Definitions

  • This invention is in the field of medicinal chemistry.
  • the invention relates to novel azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and hexahydroazepinyl compounds and the discovery that these compounds act as blockers of calcium (Ca + ) channels.
  • Voltage-gated calcium channels serve as one of the important mechanisms for fast calcium influx into the cell.
  • Calcium channels are hetero-oligomeric proteins consisting of a pore-forming subunit ( ⁇ l), which is able to form functional channels on its own in heterologous expression systems, and a set of auxiliary or regulatory subunits. Calcium channels have been classified based on their pharmacological and/or electrophysiological properties.
  • Voltage-gated calcium channels divides them into three groups: (i) high voltage-activated (HVA) channels, which include L-, N-, P-, and Q-types; (ii) intermediate (IVA) voltage-activated R-type channels; and (iii) low voltage-activated (LVA) T-type channels (Davila, supra).
  • HVA high voltage-activated
  • IVA intermediate voltage-activated voltage-activated R-type channels
  • LVA low voltage-activated T-type channels
  • VGCC Voltage- gated calcium channels
  • VDCC voltage-dependent calcium channels
  • VSCC voltage-sensitive calcium channels
  • Voltage-sensitive calcium channels regulate intracellular calcium concentration, which affects various important neuronal functions such as cellular excitability, neurotransmitter release, hormone secretion, intracellular metabolism, neurosecretory activity and gene expression (Hu et al, Bioorganic & Medicinal Chemistry 8: 1203-1212 (2000)).
  • N-type channels are found mainly in central and peripheral neurons, being primarily located on presynaptic nerve terminals. These channels regulate the calcium flux required for depolarization-evoked release of a transmitter from synaptic endings.
  • the transmission of pain signals from the periphery to the central nervous system (CNS) is mediated by N-type calcium channels located in the spinal cord (Song et al., J. Med. Chem. 43:3474-3477 (2000)).
  • N-type calcium channel blockers have usefulness for neuroprotection and analgesia.
  • Ziconotide which is a selective N-type calcium channel blocker, has been found to have analgesic activity in animal models and neuroprotective activity in focal and global ischemia models (Song et al., supra).
  • Examples of known calcium channel blockers include flunarizine, fiuspirilene, cilnipide, PD 157767, SB-201823, SB-206284, NNC09-0026, and PD 151307 (Hu et al., supra).
  • N-type voltage-gated calcium channels play a major role in the release of synaptic mediators such as glutamate, acetylcholine, dopamine, norepinephrine, gamma-aminobutyric acid (GABA) and calcitonin gene-related peptide (CGRP).
  • the present invention is related to the use of azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and hexahydroazepinyl compounds represented by Formula I, below, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, as blockers of calcium (Ca + ) channels. Certain compounds of Formula I show selectivity as N-type calcium channel blockers.
  • the invention is also related to treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels in a mammal suffering from excess activity of said channels by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, as described herein.
  • the invention is related to treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of N-type calcium channels in a mammal suffering from excess activity of said channels by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, as described herein.
  • Another aspect of the present invention is directed to the use of the novel compounds of Formula I, and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates, as blockers of N-type calcium channels.
  • a further aspect of the present invention is to provide a method for treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain (e.g., acute pain, chronic pain, which includes but is not limited to neuropathic pain and inflammatory pain, or surgical pain), migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (e.g., Alzheimer's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), or Parkinson's disease), depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia, by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration.
  • pain e.g., acute pain, chronic pain, which includes but is not limited to neuropathic pain and inflammatory pain, or surgical pain
  • migraine e.g., a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (e.g., Alzheimer's disease, amy
  • a further aspect of the present invention is to provide a pharmaceutical composition useful for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium ion channels, especially N- type calcium ion channels, said pharmaceutical composition containing an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in a mixture with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • an aspect of the invention is to provide a method of modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in a mammal, wherein said method comprises administering to the mammal an effective amount of at least one compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
  • a further aspect of the present invention is to provide radiolabeled compounds of Formula I and the use of such compounds, or their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs or solvates, as radioligands for their binding site on the calcium channel.
  • a further aspect of the invention is to provide a method for screening a candidate compound for the ability to bind to a receptor using a 3 H, 11 C, or 14 C radiolabeled compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
  • This method comprises a) introducing a fixed concentration of the radiolabeled compound to the receptor to form a mixture; b) titrating the mixture with a candidate compound; and c) determining the binding of the candidate compound to said receptor.
  • a further aspect of the invention is to provide the use of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder, depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia in a mammal.
  • the invention provides the use of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating acute pain, chronic pain, or surgical pain.
  • One aspect of the present invention is based on the use of compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, as blockers of Ca + channels.
  • compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof are useful for treating disorders responsive to the blockade of calcium ion channels.
  • compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof selectively block N-type calcium ion channels and, thus, are useful for treating disorders responsive to the selective blockade of N-type calcium ion channels.
  • R 1 and R 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , Z 4 , and Z 5 , wherein: Z 1 is
  • Z 3 is :R 8 R 9 — (CH 2 )p—D-R 14
  • Z is Z 1 , Z 2 or Z 4 when R 3 is hydrogen;
  • R 4 and R 5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or [0032] R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R 16 -C(O)-; and R 16 -SO 2 -, wherein
  • R 16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or [0035] R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, or S, wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl;
  • R 6 and R 7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, S, or SO 2 , wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, S, or SO 2 , wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
  • R 4 or R 5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R 6 and R 7 is other than hydrogen; or
  • R 6 and R 7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
  • R 7 is hydrogen;
  • R 4 is hydrogen, alkyl or hydroxyalkyl; and
  • R 5 and R 6 together form a bridge -CH 2 -CH 2 -CH 2 - or -CH 2 -CHG 1 -CHG 2 -CH 2 -, wherein G 1 and G 2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group;
  • R 32 and R 33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
  • R 33 is hydrogen and R 32 is as defined above;
  • R 32 and R 33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C 3-7 cycloalkyl ring;
  • R 32 and R 4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl;
  • R 33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl;
  • R 5 , R 6 , and R 7 are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 and R 13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
  • R 14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy,
  • R 15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
  • R 30 and R 31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
  • A is O, -C(O)-, CH 2 , or absent (a covalent bond), and B is CH or N, or
  • x is 0 or 1
  • y is O or 1;
  • m is 0, 1, 2, or 3;
  • n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5;
  • p is O, 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • q is 0, 1, 2, or 3.
  • the carbon to which the -NR 4 R 5 group is attached can be a chiral center.
  • the carbon at the 3 -position of the azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidine, and hexahydroazepine ring, i.e., the carbon where the benzenesulfonamide group is attached, can also be a chiral center. Accordingly, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
  • the groups R 10 -R 13 when they are not equal to H, each take the place of a hydrogen atom that would otherwise be present in any position on the phenyl ring to which the particular R group is attached.
  • optional substituents attached to aryl, phenyl, and heteroaryl rings each take the place of a hydrogen atom that would otherwise be present in any position on the aryl or heteroaryl rings.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of Formula I:
  • R 1 and R 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3- tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, and aminocarbonylalkyl;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , Z 4 , and Z 5 , wherein Z 1 is
  • R 4 and R 5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycl
  • R 16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or [0073] R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, or S, wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl;
  • R 6 and R 7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and benzyloxyalkyl; or
  • R 7 is hydrogen, R 4 is hydrogen or alkyl, and R 5 and R 6 together form a bridge -CH 2 -CH 2 -CH 2 - or -CH 2 -CHG 1 -CHG 2 -CH 2 -, wherein G 1 and G 2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group;
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 and R 13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
  • R 14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy,
  • R 14a and R 14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
  • R 15 is phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino;
  • R 30 and R 31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
  • A is O, -C(O)-, CH 2 , or absent, and B is CH or N; or
  • m 0, 1, 2 or 3;
  • n 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5;
  • p is O, 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • q is O, 1, 2, or 3;
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds represented by Formula II: and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, and solvates thereof, wherein R 1 , R 2 , Z, and q are as defined above.
  • preferred compounds falling within the scope of Formula II include those represented by Formula III:
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 0 (azetidinyl).
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 1 (pyrrolidinyl).
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 2 (piperidinyl).
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 3 (hexahydroazepinyl).
  • R 1 and R 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and nitro. More preferably, R 1 and R 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci -6 alkyl, halo(Ci.
  • R 1 and R 2 are independently hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, fluoromethyl, cyano, nitro, methoxy or difiuoromethoxy. More preferably, R 1 is hydrogen and R 2 is trifluoromethyl, or both R 1 and R 2 are hydrogen. Preferably, R 2 is in the meta-position of the phenyl ring.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are those where R 3 is alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, or alkoxycarbonylalkyl.
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, 3- tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl and aminocarbonylalkyl; more preferably selected from Ci -6 alkyl, C 3-6 cycloalkyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl(Ci- 3 )alkyl, C 3-6 cycloalkyl(d -3 )alkyl, Ci -3 alkoxy(Ci. 6 )alkyl, hydroxy(Ci.
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl. More advantageously, R 3 is cyclopropyl, methyl, iso-propyl, or
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z 1 , and R 4 and R 5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy,
  • Useful compounds include those where R 4 and R 5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, unsubstituted phenyl, and phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, Ci -6 alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_ 6 )alkyl, amino(Ci- 6 )alkyl, C 1-6 alkylamino(Ci- 6 )alkyl, di(Ci
  • R 4 and R 5 are independently hydrogen, methyl or hydroxyethyl, or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form 1 -pyrrolidinyl, 4-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or 4-methylpiperazinyl.
  • useful compounds in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents, preferably one or two substituents, independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R 5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylamino
  • R 4 or R 5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R 6 and R 7 is other than hydrogen.
  • Useful hydroxyalkyl groups for R 5 optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with an optionally substituted aryl or an optionally substituted benzyl include, for example, hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2- hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, 2-hydroxy-l-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-phenylethyl, 2-benzyl-2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxy-l- phenylethyl, l-benzyl-2-hydroxyethyl, and 2-hydroxy-l-phenylpropyl.
  • Useful alkyl groups for R 5 optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo include, for example, C 1-6 alkyl optionally substituted with optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, or optionally substituted heterocyclo, such as methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, 1-methylpropyl, Ci -3 alkyl substituted at the 1 -position with optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, such as 2- pyridylmethyl, 3-pyridylmethyl, 2-thienylmethyl,
  • Useful substituted alkyl groups for R 5 include Ci -3 alkyl substituted with unsubstituted cycloalkyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino and dialkylamino; unsubstituted benzyl; unsubstitued benzyloxy; unsubstituted heteroaryl; or unsubstituted heterocyclo.
  • Useful optionally substituted heteroaryl groups for R 5 include 1-, 2-, or 3-pyridyl, 2-pyrazinyl, and 3-isoxazolyl.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R 5 is R 16 -C(O)- wherein R 16 is as defined above.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 16 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, or phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R 5 is R 16 -SC>2- where R 16 is as defined above.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 16 is alkyl, especially methyl; phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and alkylcarbonylamino; or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4- tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R 5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl.
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 5 is, for example, 2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, or 2-hydroxy-l- methylpropyl.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z 1 and R 6 and R 7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituent
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z 1 , and R 6 is hydrogen and R 7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, S, or SO 2 , wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O, S, or SO 2 , wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z 1 , and R 6 is hydrogen and R 7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the
  • R 7 is preferably selected from the group consisting of alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and benzyloxyalkyl.
  • R 7 is selected from the group consisting of straight chain C 1-6 alkyl; branched chain C 3-6 alkyl; hydroxy(Ci_6)alkyl; C 3-6 cycloalkyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of Ci -6 alkyl, C 3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci -3 alkylamino, di(Ci -3 )alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci-6)alkyl, and Ci -6 alkoxy; unsubstituted benzyl; benzyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of Ci -6 alkyl, C 3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci -3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci)
  • R 7 is methyl; propyl; iso-propyl; butyl; tert-butyl; sec-butyl; iso-butyl; hydroxymethyl; 1- hydroxyethyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, butyl, tert-butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; unsubstituted benzyl; benzyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso- propyl, butyl, tert-butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; 1-benz
  • R 4 and R 5 together form a 5- or 6-membered heterocycle as described above, or R 4 and R 5 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 6 and R 7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 6 and R 7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C 3-6 cycloalkyl ring, which is preferably cyclopentyl or cyclohexyl.
  • heterocyclic groups include pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, and piperidinyl.
  • compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 6 and R 7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C 3-7 cycloalkyl ring, wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring, such as 6-oxa-bicyclo[3.1.0]hexane.
  • compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 6 and R 7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C 3-7 cycloalkyl ring, wherein one carbon atom is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring, such as l,4-dioxa-spiro[4.5]decane.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 7 is hydrogen; R 4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R 5 and R 6 together form a bridge - CH 2 -CH 2 -CH 2 - or -CH 2 -CHG 1 -CHG 2 -CH 2 -, wherein G 1 and G 2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 7 is hydrogen, R 4 is hydrogen, methyl or ethyl, and R 5 and R 6 together form a bridge -CH 2 - CH 2 -CH 2 - or -CH 2 -CHG 1 -CHG 2 -CH 2 -, wherein G 1 and G 2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group.
  • R 5 and R 6 together form -CH 2 -CH 2 -CH 2 -.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 and x, y, and m are each 0 (zero).
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 , m is 1, and x and y are each 0.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 and x is 0. [0124] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 and x is 1.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 and y is 0.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z 1 and y is 1.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where y is 1 and R 32 and R 33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or R 33 is hydrogen and R 32 is as defined above.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 32 is hydroxy or alkyl, such as Ci -3 alkyl, and R 33 is hydrogen.
  • Useful compounds also include those where R 32 and R 33 are both alkyl, such as Ci -3 alkyl, and preferably methyl.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R 32 and R 33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C 3-7 cycloalkyl ring, preferably cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R 32 and R 4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R 33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R 5 , R 6 and R 7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl.
  • useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R 32 and R 4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R 33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R 5 , R 6 and R 7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl
  • Useful compounds include those, where x is 0 or 1, m is 0, 1, 2, or 3, R 33 is hydrogen or alkyl, R 6 is hydrogen and R 7 is hydrogen, alkyl, preferably Ci -3 alkyl, carboxy or alkoxycarbonyl, preferably Ci -4 alkoxycarbonyl, and R 5 is hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, preferably Ci -3 hydroxyalkyl, or alkoxycarbonyl, preferably Ci -4 alkoxycarbonyl.
  • Suitable heterocyclic rings formed by R 32 and R 4 include 2- piperidinyl, l-hydroxyethyl-2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl, 1-tert- butoxycarbonyl-2-carboxy-3-piperidinyl, 4-piperidinyl, 1-tert- butoxycarbonyl-2-carboxy-4-piperidinyl, 2-pyrrolidinyl, 1 -hydroxyethyl-2- pyrrolidinyl, 3-pyrrolidinyl, 2-carboxy-4-isopropyl-3-pyrrolidinyl, 3-methyl- 3-pyrrolidinyl, and 4,4-dimethyl-3-pyrrolidinyl.
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , and R 13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, C 1-6 alkyl, Ci -6 alkoxy, halogen, halo(Ci. 6 )alkyl, hydroxy, hydroxy(Ci. 6 )alkyl, cyano, amino, amino(Ci-6)alkyl, Ci -3 alkylamino, and di(Ci-3)alkylamino.
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , and R 13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci -4 alkyl, Ci -3 alkoxy, halo, halo(Ci -3 )alkyl, cyano, amino, amino (Ci -3 )alkyl, Ci -3 alkylamino, and di(Ci -3 )alkylamino.
  • R 10 , R 11 , R 12 , and R 13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, methyl, ethyl, methoxy, ethoxy, trifluoromethyl, cyano, amino, methylamino, and dimethylamino, and especially halogen.
  • R 10 and R 12 are both hydrogen.
  • either or both R 11 and R 13 are at the para-position of their respective phenyl rings.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z 3 and R 14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents
  • R 14a and R 14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl
  • Useful compounds include those where R 14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, and cyano; naphthyl; quinolinyl; and pyridyl.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 14 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; preferably independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of C 1-6 alkyl, C 1- 6 alkoxy, halo, halo(Ci_3)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, Ci -3 alkylamino, and di(Ci_ 3)alkylamino.
  • R 14 is a phenyl group substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-propyl, tert-butyl, methoxy, ethoxy, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, methylamino, and dime thy lamino.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 14 is phenyl substituted, preferably at the para-position, with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy any of which are unsubstituted or substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano, and preferably substituted with halogen.
  • Useful compounds also include those where R 14 is unsubstituted naphthyl, quinolinyl or pyridyl.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 14 is -NR 14a R 14b , wherein R 14a and R 14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably
  • R 8 and R 9 are both hydrogen when R 14 is one of naphthyl; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with benzyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with phenoxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; or phenyl substituted with benzyloxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 14 is alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 15 is phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino.
  • R 15 is preferably phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 15 is phenyl substituted with Ci -6 alkyl, Ci -6 alkoxy, halogen, halo(Ci_ 3)alkyl, amino, Ci -3 alkylamino or di(Ci-3)alkylamino; and more preferably substituted with propyl, butyl, pentyl, propoxy, butoxy, pentoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, amino, methylamino or dimethylamino.
  • Useful compounds also include those where R 15 is naphthyl substituted with amino, alkylamino or dialkylamino; preferably substituted with amino, Ci -3 alkylamino or di(Ci -3 )alkylamino; and more preferably substituted with amino, methylamino or dimethylamino.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R 15 is alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 15 is Ci-6 alkyl substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group of optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted naphthyl, and optionally substituted pyridyl.
  • Useful compounds include also those where D is -NH- or -N(alkyl)-.
  • Useful compounds of the present invention include those where Z is Z 5 and R 30 and R 31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as Ci -4 alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_ 4 )alkyl, amino(Ci.
  • Useful compounds of the present invention include those where m is O or l.
  • Z is Z 2 and n is 0, 1 or 2.
  • Z is Z 3 and p is 0, 1 or 2.
  • q is 2.
  • the invention also relates to compounds represented by Formula IV:
  • R ⁇ R 7 , R 32 , R 33 , x, y, m, and q are as defined above.
  • Preferred values for R 1 - R 7 , R 32 , R 33 , x, y, m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • the invention also relates to compounds represented by Formula V:
  • R ⁇ R 7 , m and q are as defined above.
  • Preferred values for R ⁇ R 7 , m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • R . 1 - ⁇ R3 and q are as described for Formula V;
  • R 41 and R 51 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; and
  • R 18 and R 19 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
  • R 41 and R 51 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; and more preferably independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl.
  • Useful compounds include those where R 41 and R 51 both are hydrogen, or R 41 is hydrogen and R 51 is Ci -3 alkyl, preferably methyl.
  • R 18 and R 19 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-6 alkyl, C 3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci -3 alkylamino, di(Ci -3 )alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci_6)alkyl, and C 1 .
  • Ci -4 alkyl more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci -4 alkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci -3 alkylamino, di(Ci -3 )alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci -3 )alkyl, and Ci -4 alkoxy; and more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, iso-propyl, tert-butyl, cyano, fiuoro, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, nitro, trifluoromethyl, methoxy, iso-propoxy, and tert- butoxy.
  • Useful compounds of Formula VI include those where R 18 and R 19 are both hydrogen, or R 18 is hydrogen and R 19 is methyl, tert-butyl, cyano, fiuoro, methylamino, dimethylamino, trifluoromethyl or methoxy, and especially cyano.
  • R ⁇ R 3 , m, and q are as defined above for Formula I;
  • R 42 and R 52 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or R 42 and
  • R , 52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or a 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR 17 , O or S, wherein R 17 is hydrogen or Ci -3 alkyl;
  • R 20 and R 21 are independently H or CH 3 .
  • R »42 and R » 52 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; more preferably selected from hydrogen, C 1-6 alkyl, and hydroxy(Ci.
  • R 42 and R 52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring selected from the group consisting of oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, 4- methylpiperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, and tetrahydropyridyl.
  • R 42 and R 52 are independently hydrogen, methyl or hydroxyethyl; or R 42 and R 52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form 1 -pyrrolidinyl, 4-thiomorpholinyl, or 4-methylpiperazinyl.
  • Useful compounds of Formula VII include those where one of R 20 or R 21 is CH 3 .
  • Other useful compounds of Formula VII include those where R 20 and R 21 are both H when R 42 and R 52 together form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring.
  • useful compounds of Formula VII include those where R 42 and R 52 are both hydrogen, or R 42 is hydrogen and R 52 is alkyl. especially methyl.
  • m is 1 in compounds of Formula VII.
  • R ⁇ R 7 , R 32 , R 33 , and q are as defined above.
  • R , 33 , and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • Useful compounds of Formula VIII include those where R ,33 is hydrogen. Useful compounds of Formula VIII also include those where R 32 is hydroxy or alkyl or R 32 and R 33 together form a C 3-6 cycloalkyl. Useful compounds of Formula VIII also include those where R 32 and R 4 together form a 5-membered heterocyclic ring.
  • R ⁇ R 7 , R 32 , R 33 , m and q are as defined above.
  • Preferred values for R ⁇ R 7 , R 32 , R 33 , m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • Useful compounds of Formula IX include those where R 32 and R 33 together form C 5-6 cycloalkyl, R 6 and R 7 are hydrogen, m is 0, and R ⁇ R 5 are as defined above.
  • Another group of useful compounds are those where R 33 is hydrogen, R 32 is hydroxy and m is 0, and R ⁇ R 7 are as defined above.
  • R J -R 3 , R 8 -R 13 , A, B, q, and n are as defined above for Formulae I-III.
  • Preferred values for R ⁇ R 3 , R 8 -R 13 , A, B, n, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of Formula XI:
  • R J -R 3 , R 8 , R 9 , R 14 , D, p, and q are as defined previously for Formula I.
  • preferred values for R 1 -R 3 , R 8 , R 9 , R 14 , D, p and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • R ⁇ R 3 , R 15 and q are as defined previously for Formula I.
  • preferred values for R ⁇ R 3 , R 15 and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • R J -R 3 , R 30 , R 31 , and q are as defined previously for Formula I.
  • preferred values for R ⁇ R 3 , R 30 , R 31 and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
  • Exemplary preferred compounds useful in the present invention include: N-[ 1 -(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
  • Another group of useful compounds of the invention include: (2S) N-[I -(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; (2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)-piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
  • Another group of useful compounds of the invention include: N-cyclopropyl-N-(l- ⁇ 3-[bis-(4-fiuorophenyl)amino]propyl ⁇ -piperidin-3-yl)-
  • Useful cycloalkyl groups are selected from saturated C 3- I 2 cycloalkyl.
  • Typical cycloalkyl groups include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl, and cyclooctyl.
  • bicycloalkyl refers to saturated alicyclic hydrocarbon systems consisting of two rings and having two or more atoms in common.
  • Useful bicycloalkyl groups are selected from C 4-I2 bicycloalkyl.
  • Typical bicycloalkyl groups include bicyclobutyl, bicyclopentyl, bicyclohexyl, bicycloheptyl, and bicyclooctyl, especially bicyclo[3.1.0]hept- 3-yl.
  • Useful halo or halogen groups include fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
  • Useful alkyl groups are selected from straight-chained and branched Ci-io alkyl groups, more preferably straight chain C 1-6 alkyl groups and branched chain C 1-6 alkyl groups.
  • Typical C 1-10 alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, sec -butyl, tert-butyl, z ' so-butyl, 3-pentyl, hexyl and octyl, among others.
  • Useful alkenyl groups are selected from C 2-6 alkenyl groups, preferably C 2-4 alkenyl.
  • Typical C 2-4 alkenyl groups include ethenyl, propenyl, 2-propenyl, isopropenyl, butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, and sec- butenyl.
  • Useful alkynyl groups are selected from C 2- 6 alkynyl groups, preferably C 2-4 alkynyl.
  • Typical C 2-4 alkynyl groups include ethynyl, propynyl, 2-propynyl, butynyl, 2-butynyl, and 3-butynyl groups.
  • Useful arylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted by any of the C 6-I4 aryl groups mentioned below.
  • Typical arylalkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl, and naphthylmethyl.
  • Useful arylalkenyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 2-6 alkenyl groups substituted by any of the C 6-I4 aryl groups mentioned below.
  • Useful arylalkynyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 2-6 alkynyl groups substituted by any of the C 6- I 4 aryl groups mentioned below.
  • benzyloxybenzyl refers to a benzyl group substituted by a benzyloxy group at the phenyl ring of the benzyl group.
  • Useful benzyloxybenzyl groups include 4-(benzyloxy)benzyl.
  • Useful cycloalkylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci.io alkyl groups substituted by any of the above-mentioned cycloalkyl groups.
  • Useful haloalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted by one or more fluorine, chlorine, bromine or iodine atoms (e.g., fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, pentafluoroethyl, 1,1-difluoroethyl and trichloromethyl groups).
  • Useful hydroxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted by hydroxy (e.g., hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, hydroxypropyl and hydroxybutyl groups, and especially hydroxymethyl, 1- hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3 -hydroxybutyl, and 2-hydroxy-l- methylpropyl).
  • Useful alkoxy groups include oxygen substituted by one of the C 1-10 alkyl groups mentioned above.
  • Useful alkoxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted with any of the above-mentioned alkoxy groups.
  • Useful haloalkoxy groups include oxygen substituted by one of the Ci-io haloalkyl groups mentioned above (e.g., fluoromethoxy, difluoromethoxy, and trifiuoromethoxy).
  • Useful aryl groups are C 6-14 aryl, especially C 6-10 aryl.
  • Typical C 6- I 4 aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, phenanthryl, anthracyl, indenyl, azulenyl, biphenyl, biphenylenyl, and fluorenyl groups, more preferably phenyl, naphthyl, and biphenyl groups.
  • heteroaryl refers to groups having 5 to 14 ring atoms, with 6, 10 or 14 ⁇ electrons shared in a cyclic array, and containing carbon atoms and 1, 2, or 3 oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur heteroatoms.
  • heteroaryl groups include thienyl, benzo[b]thienyl, naphtho[2,3-b]thienyl, thianthrenyl, furyl, benzofuryl, pyranyl, isobenzofuranyl, benzooxazonyl, chromenyl, xanthenyl, 2H- pyrrolyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyridazinyl, isoindolyl, 3H-indolyl, indolyl, indazolyl, purinyl, isoquinolyl, quinolyl, phthalazinyl, naphthyridinyl, cinnolinyl, quinazolinyl, pteridinyl, 4aH-carbazolyl, carbazolyl, ⁇ -carbolinyl, carbazo
  • Preferred heteroaryl groups include thienyl, furyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, and isoxazolyl.
  • Useful heteroarylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1- io alkyl groups substituted by any of the heteroaryl groups mentioned below. Useful values include, for example, 2-pyridylmethyl, 3-pyridylmethyl, 4- pyridylmethyl.
  • heterocyclic and “heterocyclo” are used herein to mean saturated or wholly or partially unsaturated 3-7 membered monocyclic, or 7- 10 membered bicyclic ring system, which consist of carbon atoms and from one to four heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of O, N, and S, wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms can be optionally oxidized, the nitrogen can be optionally quaternized, and including any bicyclic group in which any of the above-defined heterocyclic rings is fused to a benzene ring, and wherein the heterocyclic ring can be substituted on a carbon atom or on a nitrogen atom if the resulting compound is stable.
  • heterocyclic include, but are not limited to, pyrrolidine, piperidine, piperazine, morpholine, imidazoline, pyrazolidine, benzodiazepines, and the like.
  • Useful heterocycloalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted by any of the above-mentioned heterocyclic groups.
  • amino or “amino group” refers to -NH 2 .
  • Useful aminoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci -I0 alkyl groups substituted with an amino group.
  • Useful diaminoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted with two amino groups.
  • Useful alkylamino and dialkylamino groups are — NHR 22 and — NR 22 R 23 , respectively, wherein R 22 and R 23 are each independently selected from a Ci -I0 alkyl group.
  • Useful alkylaminoalkyl and dialkylaminoalkyl groups are any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted by any of the above- mentioned alkylamino and dialkylamino groups, respectively.
  • Useful alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl groups include any of the above- mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted by an alkyl-SC>2-NH- group.
  • Useful aminocarbonylalkyl groups include any of the above- mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted with an aminocarbonyl group, i.e., - C(O)NH 2 .
  • Useful alkylcarbonyl groups include a carbonyl group, i.e., -C(O)-, substituted by any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups.
  • Useful haloalkylcarbonyl groups include a carbonyl group substituted by any of the above-mentioned haloalkyl groups.
  • Useful alkylcarbonylamino groups include any of the above- mentioned alkylcarbonyl groups attached to an amino nitrogen, such as methylcarbony lamino .
  • Useful mercaptoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1- io alkyl groups substituted by a -SH group.
  • carboxy refers to -COOH.
  • Useful carboxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C 1-10 alkyl groups substituted by -COOH.
  • ureido refers to -NH-C(O)-NH 2 .
  • the term “optionally substituted” refers to a group that can be unsubstituted or substituted.
  • Optional substituents on optionally substituted groups include one or more groups, preferably 1, 2, or 3 groups, independently selected from the group consisting of halo, halo(Ci. 6 )alkyl, aryl, heterocycle, cycloalkyl, C 1-6 alkyl, C2-6 alkenyl, C 2-6 alkynyl, aryl(Ci_ 6 )alkyl, aryl(C 2 - 6 )alkenyl, aryl(C 2 - 6 )alkynyl, cycloalkyl(Ci- 6 )alkyl, heterocyclo(Ci_ 6 )alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_ 6 )alkyl, amino(Ci- 6 )alkyl, carboxy(Ci_ 6 )alkyl, alkoxy(Ci.
  • Preferred optional substituents include halo, halo(Ci- 6 )alkyl, hydroxy(Ci- 6 )alkyl, amino(Ci- 6 )alkyl, hydroxy, nitro, C 1-6 alkyl, alkoxy, and amino.
  • prodrugs are considered to be any covalently bonded carriers that release the active parent drug in vivo.
  • Non-limiting examples of prodrugs include esters or amides of compounds of any of Formulae I-XIII having hydroxyalkyl or aminoalkyl as a substituent, and these may be prepared by reacting such compounds with anhydrides such as succinic anhydride.
  • the invention disclosed herein is also intended to encompass any of the disclosed compounds being isotopically-labelled by having one or more atoms replaced by an atom having a different atomic mass or mass number.
  • isotopes that can be incorporated into the disclosed compounds include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, fluorine and chlorine, such as 2 H, 3 H, 11 C, 13 C, 14 C, 15 N, 18 O, 17 0, 31 P, 32 P, 35 S, 18 F, and 36 Cl, respectively, and preferably 3 H, 11 C, and 14 C.
  • isotopically- labeled compounds of the present invention can be prepared by methods known in the art.
  • the present invention is also directed specifically to 3 H, 11 C, or 14 C radiolabeled compounds of any of Formulae I-XIII, as well as their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates, and the use of any such compounds as radioligands for their binding site on the calcium channel.
  • one use of the labeled compounds of the present invention is the characterization of specific receptor binding.
  • Another use of a labeled compound of the present invention is an alternative to animal testing for the evaluation of structure-activity relationships.
  • the receptor assay may be performed at a fixed concentration of a labeled compound of the invention and at increasing concentrations of a test compound in a competition assay.
  • a tritiated compound of any of Formulae I- XIII can be prepared by introducing tritium into the particular compound, for example, by catalytic dehalogenation with tritium.
  • This method may include reacting a suitably halogen-substituted precursor of the compound with tritium gas in the presence of a suitable catalyst, for example, Pd/C, in the presence or absence of a base.
  • a suitable catalyst for example, Pd/C
  • Other suitable methods for preparing tritiated compounds can be found in Filer, Isotopes in the Physical and Biomedical Sciences, Vol. 1, Labeled Compounds (Part A), Chapter 6 (1987).
  • R elabeled compounds can be prepared by employing starting materials having a 14 C carbon.
  • l ⁇ -labeled compounds can be prepared by employing starting materials having a 11 C carbon.
  • Some of the compounds disclosed herein may contain one or more asymmetric centers and may thus give rise to enantiomers, diastereomers, and other stereoisomeric forms.
  • the present invention is meant to encompass the uses of all such possible forms, as well as their racemic and resolved forms and mixtures thereof.
  • the individual enantiomers may be separated according to methods known to those of ordinary skill in the art in view of the present disclosure.
  • the compounds described herein contain olefinic double bonds or other centers of geometric asymmetry, and unless specified otherwise, it is intended that they include both E and Z geometric isomers. All tautomers are intended to be encompassed by the present invention as well.
  • stereoisomers is a general term for all isomers of individual molecules that differ only in the orientation of their atoms in space. It includes enantiomers and isomers of compounds with more than one chiral center that are not mirror images of one another (diastereomers).
  • chiral center refers to a carbon atom to which four different groups are attached.
  • enantiomer and “enantiomeric” refer to a molecule that cannot be superimposed on its mirror image and hence is optically active wherein the enantiomer rotates the plane of polarized light in one direction and its mirror image compound rotates the plane of polarized light in the opposite direction.
  • racemic refers to a mixture of equal parts of enantiomers and which mixture is optically inactive.
  • resolution refers to the separation or concentration or depletion of one of the two enantiomeric forms of a molecule.
  • a and an refer to one or more.
  • the invention disclosed herein also encompasses the use of salts of the disclosed compounds, including all non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof of the disclosed compounds.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable addition salts include inorganic and organic acid addition salts and basic salts.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, metal salts such as sodium salt, potassium salt, cesium salt and the like; alkaline earth metals such as calcium salt, magnesium salt and the like; organic amine salts such as triethylamine salt, pyridine salt, picoline salt, ethanolamine salt, triethanolamine salt, dicyclohexylamine salt, N,N'-dibenzylethylenediamine salt and the like; inorganic acid salts such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, phosphate, sulphate and the like; organic acid salts such as citrate, lactate, tartrate, maleate, fumarate, mandelate, acetate, dichloroacetate, trifluoroacetate, oxalate, format
  • Acid addition salts can be formed by mixing a solution of the particular compound of the present invention with a solution of a pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic acid such as hydrochloric acid, fumaric acid, maleic acid, succinic acid, acetic acid, citric acid, tartaric acid, carbonic acid, phosphoric acid, oxalic acid, dichloroacetic acid, or the like.
  • Basic salts can be formed by mixing a solution of the compound of the present invention with a solution of a pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic base such as sodium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, choline hydroxide, sodium carbonate and the like.
  • the invention disclosed herein is also meant to encompass solvates of any of the disclosed compounds.
  • One type of solvate is a hydrate. Solvates typically do not significantly alter the physiological activity or toxicity of the compounds, and as such may function as pharmacological equivalents.
  • compounds of Formulae I-XIII are blockers of calcium (Ca 2+ ) channels, a number of diseases and conditions mediated by calcium ion influx can be treated by employing these compounds.
  • the present invention is thus directed generally to a method for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels, and particularly the selective blockade of N-type calcium channels, in an animal suffering from, or at risk of suffering from, said disorder, said method comprising administering to the animal an effective amount of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
  • the present invention is further directed to a method of modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in an animal in need thereof, said method comprising administering to the animal at least one compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
  • the present invention provides a method of treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, the neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain (e.g., chronic pain, neuropathic pain, inflammatory pain, or acute pain), migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (e.g., Alzheimer's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), or Parkinson's disease), depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia.
  • the invention provides a method of treating pain.
  • the type of pain treated is chronic pain.
  • the type of pain treated is neuropathic pain.
  • the type of pain treated is inflammatory pain.
  • the type of pain treated is acute pain.
  • such method of treatment, prevention, or amelioration requires administering to an animal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration an amount of a compound of the present invention that is therapeutically effective in achieving said treatment, prevention or amelioration.
  • the amount of such compound is the amount that is effective as to block calcium channels in vivo.
  • Chronic pain includes, but is not limited to, inflammatory pain, postoperative pain, cancer pain, osteoarthritis pain associated with metastatic cancer, trigeminal neuralgia, acute herpetic and postherpetic neuralgia, diabetic neuropathy, causalgia, brachial plexus avulsion, occipital neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, fibromyalgia, gout, phantom limb pain, burn pain, and other forms of neuralgia, neuropathic, and idiopathic pain syndromes.
  • the inflammatory process is a complex series of biochemical and cellular events activated in response to tissue injury or the presence of foreign substances (Levine, Inflammatory Pain, In: Textbook of Pain, Wall and Melzack eds., 3 rd ed., 1994). Inflammation often occurs at the site of injured tissue, or foreign material, and contributes to the process of tissue repair and healing.
  • the cardinal signs of inflammation include erythema (redness), heat, edema (swelling), pain and loss of function (ibid.).
  • the majority of patients with inflammatory pain do not experience pain continually, but rather experience enhanced pain when the inflamed site is moved or touched. Inflammatory pain includes, but is not limited to, that associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis.
  • Chronic neuropathic pain is a heterogenous disease state with an unclear etiology.
  • chronic neuropathic pain the pain can be mediated by multiple mechanisms. This type of pain generally arises from injury to the peripheral or central nervous tissue.
  • the syndromes include pain associated with spinal cord injury, multiple sclerosis, post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, phantom pain, causalgia, and reflex sympathetic dystrophy and lower back pain.
  • Chronic pain is different from acute pain in that patients suffer the abnormal pain sensations that can be described as spontaneous pain, continuous superficial burning and/or deep aching pain.
  • the pain can be evoked by heat-, cold-, and mechano-hyperalgesia or by heat-, cold-, or mechano-allodynia.
  • Neuropathic pain can be caused by injury or infection of peripheral sensory nerves. It includes, but is not limited to, pain from peripheral nerve trauma, herpes virus infection, diabetes mellitus, causalgia, plexus avulsion, neuroma, limb amputation, and vasculitis. Neuropathic pain is also caused by nerve damage from chronic alcoholism, human immunodeficiency virus infection, hypothyroidism, uremia, or vitamin deficiences. Stroke (spinal or brain) and spinal cord injury can also induce neuropathic pain. Cancer- related neuropathic pain results from tumor growth compression of adjacent nerves, brain, or spinal cord. In addition, cancer treatments, including chemotherapy and radiation therapy, can also cause nerve injury.
  • Neuropathic pain includes but is not limited to pain caused by nerve injury such as, for example, the pain from which diabetics suffer.
  • the present invention is also directed to the use of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels (e.g., any of the disorders listed above) in an animal suffering from said disorder.
  • the disorder is responsive to the selective blockade of N-type calcium channels.
  • the present invention is also directed to the use of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in an animal in need thereof.
  • R 1 , R 2 , and R 3 are as defined above for Formula I.
  • R 6 and R 7 are as defined above, or R 6 and R 7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C 3-7 cyclolalkyl group.
  • R 3 -R 5 , R 7 and R 24 are as defined above.
  • R 3 , R 4 , R 7 and R 24 are as defined above and R and R" are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo.
  • a further method for preparing compounds of Formula I where Z is Z 1 can be follows:
  • R 3 -R 5 , R 7 , and R 24 are as defined above.
  • R 3 , R 4 , R 7 , R 16 and R 24 are as defined above.
  • R 3 , R 4 , R 7 and R 24 are as defined above and R 27 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted aryl, and optionally substituted benzyl.
  • the carbons to which R 7 and R 27 are attached can be chiral centers and, thus, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
  • R 3 , R 4 , R 7 , and R 24 are as defined above and R 28 and R 29 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted aryl, and optionally substituted benzyl.
  • the carbon atoms to which R 7 , R 28 and R 29 are attached can be chiral centers and, thus, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
  • R*-R 3 and R 10 -R 13 are as defined above for Formula I.
  • the amine and carboxylic acid are added in dry THF under nitrogen atmosphere.
  • HOBT, EDCI, and triethylamine are added to the mixture, and the mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight.
  • the resulting mixture is partitioned between ethyl acetate and 1.0 M sodium chloride.
  • the organic layer is separated, dried and concentrated to give a crude product, which can be purified by crystallization by hexane/ether.
  • R*-R 3 and R 10 -R 13 are as described above.
  • R , 1 - ⁇ R3 are as defined for Formula I
  • X is Cl or Br
  • R' can be, for example, alkenyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted naphthyl, quinolinyl, pyridyl, or -(CH 2 ) p -D-NR 14a R 14b , wherein p, D, R 14a and R 14b are as defined above.
  • the amine i.e., the piperidinyl compound
  • R' is an optionally substituted phenyl.
  • reaction mixture is stirred for 12 hours at 80 0 C and the solvent is evaporated. The residue can be purified by flash chromatography to give the desired product.
  • corresponding aldehydes, R'C(O)H can be used as follows: sodium triacetoxyborohydride (1.4 eq.) is added to a solution of an amine and an aldehyde in dichloroethane. The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 12 hours. After this period, the solution is decanted and purified by flash chromatography to give the desired product.
  • R*-R 3 are as defined for Formula I.
  • sulfonamide and approximately 0.5 mmol of the appropriate sulfonyl chloride are dissolved in 5 mL of DCM and combined with 1.5 eq. DIEA (0.134 mL) that is added by syringe. The mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature, and then concentrated under vacuum. The resulting product can be purified by using a column of silica gel with a gradient of 0 % to 20 % EtOAc in hexanes and the pure material is concentrated from the eluant.
  • R' and R" are as defined above for R 30 and R 31 .
  • Compounds of the present invention were assessed by calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays for calcium channel blocker activity.
  • One aspect of the present invention is based on the use of the compounds herein described as N-type calcium channel blockers.
  • certain compounds herein described show selectivity as N-type calcium channel blockers. Based upon this property, these compounds are considered useful in treating, preventing, or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (such as, e.g., Alzheimer's disease, ALS, or Parkinson's disease), a psychosis, depression, anxiety, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia.
  • the compounds of the present invention are also expected to be effective in treating, preventing or ameliorating pain, such as acute pain, chronic pain, which includes but is not limited to neuropathic pain and inflammatory pain, or surgical pain.
  • the present invention is directed to compounds of Formulae I-XIII that are blockers of calcium channels.
  • those compounds having preferred N-type calcium channel blocking properties exhibit an IC 50 of about 100 ⁇ M or less in the calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays described herein.
  • the compounds of the present invention exhibit an IC50 of 10 ⁇ M or less.
  • the compounds of the present invention exhibit an IC50 of about 1.0 ⁇ M or less.
  • Compounds of the present invention can be tested for their N-type and L-type Ca + channel blocking activity by the following calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays.
  • compounds useful in the present invention are those represented by any one of Formulae I-XIII that exhibit selectivity for N-type calcium channels over L-type calcium channels in the calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays described herein.
  • the phrase "selectivity for N-type calcium channels over L-type calcium channels" is used herein to mean that the ratio of an IC50 for L-type channel blocking activity for a compound of the present invention over an IC50 for N-type channel blocking activity for the same compound is more than 1, i.e., LTCC IC 50 / NTCC IC 50 > 1.
  • compounds of the present invention exhibit an LTCC IC50 / NTCC IC50 ratio of about 2 or more, about 10 or more, about 20 or more, about 30 or more, about 50 or more, or about 100 or more.
  • LTCC IC50 / NTCC IC50 ratio of about 2 or more, about 10 or more, about 20 or more, about 30 or more, about 50 or more, or about 100 or more.
  • cell maintenance and differentiation were purchased from Mediatech of Herndon, MD. IMR32 cells (American Type Culture Collection, ATCC, Manassas, VA) were routinely cultured in growth medium consisting of minimum essential medium containing 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS, Hyclone, Logan, UT), 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 ⁇ g/mL streptomycin, 2 mM L-glutamine, 1 mM sodium pyruvate, and Ix MEM non-essential amino acids. 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium:
  • FBS fetal bovine serum
  • streptomycin 100 fetal bovine serum
  • streptomycin 100 fetal bovine serum
  • 2 mM L-glutamine 1 mM sodium pyruvate
  • Ix MEM non-essential amino acids 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium:
  • A7r5 (ATCC) cells were maintained and routinely cultured in A7r5 growth medium consisting of Dulbecco's Modified Eagles Medium containing 10 % FBS, 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 ⁇ g/mL streptomycin, 4 mM L-glutamine, and 0.15% sodium bicarbonate. 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium: A7r5 Growth Medium plus 1 mM dibutyryl cyclic AMP (Sigma). Cells were differentiated for 8 days by replacing differentiation medium every 2-3 days.
  • A7r5 growth medium consisting of Dulbecco's Modified Eagles Medium containing 10 % FBS, 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 ⁇ g/mL streptomycin, 4 mM L-glutamine, and 0.15% sodium bicarbonate. 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium: A7r5 Growth Medium plus 1 mM dibut
  • NTCC N-type calcium channel
  • LTCC L-type calcium channel subunits
  • ⁇ lc ⁇ 2 ⁇ , and ⁇ l
  • growth medium consisting of Dulbecco's Modified Eagles Medium containing 10 % FBS, 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 ⁇ g/mL streptomycin, 4 mM L-glutamine, 500 ⁇ g/mL geneticin (G418), 20 ⁇ g/mL Blasticidin S (InVivogen, San Diego, CA) and 500 ⁇ g/mL zeocin (InVivogen).
  • IMR32 buffer 127 mM NaCl, 1 mM KCl, 2 mM MgCl 2 , 700 ⁇ M NaH 2 PO 4 , 5 mM CaCl 2 , 5 mM NaHCO 3 , 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4
  • pre- stimulated with KCl loaded as follows: 0.05 mL of IMR32 buffer, 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in IMR32 buffer containing 20 ⁇ M nitrendipine (Sigma), and 0.1 mL KCl dissolved in IMR32 buffer, plus Fluo- 4 were added (3 ⁇ M final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR).
  • Final test compound concentrations ranged from about 846 pM to about 17 ⁇ M, final nitrendipine concentration was 5 ⁇ M, and final KCl concentration was 90 mM.
  • the cells were washed twice with 0.05 mL of each compound tested in nitrendipine-containing IMR32 buffer (no KCl or Fluo- 4), and then replaced with 0.1 mL of each compound tested in nitrendipine- containing IMR32 buffer. Plates were then transferred to a Fluorimetric Imaging Plate Reader (FLIPR 96 , Molecular Devices, Inc., Sunnyvale, CA) for assay.
  • FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds (i.e., 5 minutes and 15 seconds), then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in
  • HEK293 cells stably expressing recombinant rat L-type calcium channel (LTCC) subunits ( ⁇ lc, ⁇ 2 ⁇ , and ⁇ l) were trypsinized, then seeded on poly-D-lysine-coated 96-well clear-bottom black plates (Becton Dickinson, Franklin Lakes, NJ) at 75,000 cells/well.
  • LTCC recombinant rat L-type calcium channel
  • LTCC wash buffer 127 mM NaCl, 2 mM MgCl 2 , 700 ⁇ M NaH 2 PO 4 , 5 mM CaCl 2 , 5 mM NaHCO 3 , 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4
  • LTCC wash buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 ⁇ M final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR).
  • Fluo-4 3 ⁇ M final concentration
  • FLIPR 96 for assay.
  • the FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 15 seconds, then added 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in LTCC assay buffer at final concentrations ranging from about 846 pM to about 17 ⁇ M. Fluo-4 fluorescence was then measured for 5 minutes.
  • 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in LTCC assay buffer was then added to the cells to produce a final concentration of 90 mM KCl, and fluorescence was measured for another 45 seconds. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or an in-house regression analysis software.
  • A7r5 wash buffer (127 mM NaCl, 2 mM MgCl 2 , 700 ⁇ M NaH 2 PO 4 , 5 mM CaCl 2 , 5 mM NaHCO 3 , 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4), then loaded with 0.1 mL of A7r5 wash buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 ⁇ M final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR).
  • the cells are washed with 0.1 mL A7r5 wash buffer and resuspended in 0.05 mL A7r5 assay buffer that is composed of A7r5 wash buffer plus 50 ⁇ M valinomycin (Sigma). Plates are then transferred to a FLIPR 96 for assay.
  • the FLIPR measures basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 15 seconds, then adds 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in A7r5 assay buffer at final concentrations ranging from about 846 pM to about 17 ⁇ M. Fluo-4 fluorescence is then measured for 5 minutes.
  • KCl agonist dissolved in A7r5 assay buffer is then added to the cells to produce a final concentration of 90 mM KCl, and fluorescence was measured for another 45 seconds. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or an in-house regression analysis software.
  • the betal subunit cDNA has been described by Pragnell et al. in FEBS Lett. 291: 253-258 (1991).
  • the beta3 subunit cDNA has been described by Castellano et al. in J Biol. Chem. 268: 12359-12366 (1993).
  • the alpha2delta subunit cDNA has been described by Kim et al. in Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 89: 3251-3255 (1992).
  • the alphalc subunit cDNA has been described by Koch et al. in J Biol. Chem. 265: 17786-17791 (1990).
  • the 7.0 kb cDNA containing the entire ⁇ lb open reading frame (ORF) was PCR amplified as two overlapping cDNA fragments, i.e., a 2.7 kb 5' fragment and a 4.4 kb 3' fragment.
  • the 5' fragment was amplified from rat brain cDNA using primers 1 (SEQ ID NO: 1 , TABLE 1) and 2 (SEQ ID NO:2, TABLE 1), and the 3' fragment was amplified from rat spinal cord cDNA using primers 3 (SEQ ID NO:3, TABLE 1) and 4 (SEQ ID NO:4, TABLE 1).
  • the two fragments were joined by ligation at a common restriction site to create the entire 7.0 kb cDNA.
  • This ORF encodes the protein isoform generated by alternative splicing termed "+A ⁇ SFMG ⁇ ET” according to the nomenclature of Lin et al. (Neuron 18: 153-166 (1997)). The entire cDNA was sequenced with redundant coverage on both strands. The cDNA was then inserted into the mammalian expression vector pcDNA6.2DEST (Invitrogen, Carlsbad CA) by homologous recombination using the Gateway system (Invitrogen).
  • Primers 5 (SEQ ID NO:5, TABLE 1) and 6 (SEQ ID NO:6, TABLE 1) were used for the ⁇ l cDNA amplification; primers 7 (SEQ ID NO:7, TABLE 1) and 8 (SEQ ID NO:8, TABLE 1) were used for the ⁇ 3 cDNA amplification; and primers 9 (SEQ ID NO:9, TABLE 1) and 10 (SEQ ID NO: 10, TABLE 1) were used for the ⁇ 2 ⁇ cDNA amplification. PCR products were subcloned and fully sequenced on both strands.
  • N-type Recombinant Cell Line Development N-type calcium channel expressing HEK-293 cells were created in two stages. Stage 1 was created as follows. The rat ⁇ lb, and ⁇ 3 cDNA expression constructs (2.5 ⁇ g each) were co-transfected into human embryonic kidney (HEK-293) cells by
  • Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 ⁇ g/mL blasticidin and 500 ⁇ g/mL geneticin, and incubated for 3 weeks at 37 0 C, 5 % CO 2 , 95 % humidity. Plates containing ⁇ 1 clone per well were cultured until wells positive for single clones were confluent. Individual clones were then arrayed into columns of a destination 96-well plate, and partly split into 6-well plates for culture maintenance.
  • Array plates were washed once with IMR32 buffer and cells loaded for 1 hour with 0.1 mL of IMR32 buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 ⁇ M final concentration, Molecular Probes). Then they were washed twice with 0.1 mL of IMR32 buffer, and replaced with 0.1 mL IMR32 buffer. Plates were then transferred to a FLIPR 96 for assay. The FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds, then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in IMR32 buffer and measured fluorescence for another 45 seconds. Final KCl concentration was 90 mM.
  • Stage 2 of N-type cell line development was carried out as follows.
  • the rat ⁇ 2 ⁇ cDNA expression construct (5 ⁇ g each) was transfected into the stage 1 N-type clonal cell line by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 ⁇ g/mL blasticidin, 500 ⁇ g/mL geneticin, and 250 ⁇ g/mL zeocin and incubated for 3 weeks at 37°C, 5% CO 2 , 95% humidity. Plates containing ⁇ 1 clone per well were cultured and handled according to the same steps and procedures described above for the stage 1 cell line.
  • L-type Recombinant Cell Line Development L-type calcium channel expressing HEK-293 cells were created in two stages. Stage 1 was created as follows. The rat ⁇ lc, and ⁇ l cDNA expression constructs (2.5 ⁇ g each) were co-transfected into human embryonic kidney (HEK-293) cells by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 ⁇ g/mL blasticidin and 500 ⁇ g/mL geneticin, and incubated for 3 weeks at 37 0 C, 5 % CO 2 , 95 % humidity.
  • Plates containing ⁇ 1 clone per well were cultured until wells positive for single clones were confluent. Individual clones were then arrayed into columns of a destination 96-well plate, and partly split into 6-well plates for culture maintenance. Array plates were washed once with LTCC wash (or assay) buffer and cells loaded for 1 hour with 0.1 mL of LTCC buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 ⁇ M final concentration, Molecular Probes). Then they were washed twice with 0.1 mL of LTCC buffer, and replaced with 0.1 mL LTCC buffer. Plates were then transferred to a FLIPR 96 for assay.
  • the FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds, then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in LTCC buffer and measured fluorescence for another 45 seconds. Final KCl concentration was 90 mM. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or Activity Base software. The clone with the greatest signal-to-noise ratio, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) was expanded, characterized and used for stage 2 cell line development.
  • Stage 2 of L-type cell line development was carried out as follows.
  • the rat ⁇ 2 ⁇ cDNA expression construct (5 ⁇ g each) was transfected into the stage 1 L-type clonal cell line by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 ⁇ g/mL blasticidin, 500 ⁇ g/mL geneticin, and 250 ⁇ g/mL zeocin and incubated for 3 weeks at 37°C, 5% CO 2 , 95% humidity. Plates containing ⁇ 1 clone per well were cultured and handled according to the same steps and procedures described above for the stage 1 cell line. The three clones with the greatest signal-to-noise, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) were expanded and characterized.
  • N-type Electrophysiology in Recombinant Cells For electrophysiological recording, the cells expressing ⁇ lb, ⁇ 3 and ⁇ 2 ⁇ subunits were seeded on 35 -mm culture Petri dishes at a density of approximately 10 4 cells/dish and kept in an incubator for up to three days for subsequent recordings. For recordings, the dishes were positioned on the stage of an inverted microscope (Nikon, Eclipse E600, Japan) and superfused with a bath solution comprised OfBaCl 2 (11 mM), MgCl 2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (10 mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH.
  • a bath solution comprised OfBaCl 2 (11 mM), MgCl 2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (10 mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH.
  • the pipettes were back-filled with internal solution containing CsCl (HOmM), MgCl 2 (3 mM), EGTA (3 mM), HEPES (40 mM), Mg-ATP (4 mM), Na 2 GTP (0.5 mM), and adjusted to pH 7.2 with CsOH.
  • the pipette resistance ranged from 2 to 3 MOhm and was compensated by 75-80 % by the built-in electronic circuitry.
  • N-type Electrophysiology in Neuronal Cells To determine dissociation constants in resting versus inactivated state for N-type calcium channels, neuronal cells that endogenously express N-type calcium channels can be used. For electrophysiological recording, the neuronal cells expressing N-type calcium channels are seeded on 35 -mm culture Petri dishes at a density of approximately 10 4 cells/dish and kept in an incubator for up to three days for subsequent recordings.
  • the dishes are positioned on the stage of an inverted microscope (Nikon, Eclipse E600, Japan) and superfused with a bath solution comprised OfBaCl 2 (11 mM), MgCl 2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (1O mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH.
  • a bath solution comprised OfBaCl 2 (11 mM), MgCl 2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (1O mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH.
  • Whole-cell voltage-clamp recordings are made using conventional patch-clamp techniques (Hamill et ah, Pfluegers Arch. 391: 85-100 (1981)) at room temperature (22-24 0 C).
  • the patch-clamp pipettes are pulled from WPI, thick-walled borosilicate glass (WPI, Sarasota, FL).
  • the compounds of the present invention can be tested for in vivo anticonvulsant activity after Lv., p.o., or i.p. injection using any of a number of anticonvulsant tests in mice, including the maximum electroshock seizure test (MES).
  • MES maximum electroshock seizure test
  • Maximum electroshock seizures are induced in male NSA mice weighing between 15-20 g and in male Sprague-Dawley rats weighing between 200-225 g by application of current (for mice: 50 mA, 60 pulses/sec, 0.8 msec pulse width, 1 sec duration, D. C; for rats: 99 mA, 125 pulses/sec, 0.8 msec pulse width, 2 sec duration, D.
  • mice are restrained by gripping the loose skin on their dorsal surface and saline-coated corneal electrodes are held lightly against the two corneae. Rats are allowed free movement on the bench top and ear-clip electrodes are used. Current is applied and animals are observed for a period of up to 30 seconds for the occurrence of a tonic hindlimb extensor response.
  • a tonic seizure is defined as a hindlimb extension in excess of 90 degrees from the plane of the body. Results can be treated in a quantal manner.
  • mice Male Swiss Webster NIH mice (20-30 g; Harlan, San Diego, CA) can be used in all experiments. Food is withdrawn on the day of experiment. Mice are placed in Plexiglass jars for at least 1 hour to acclimate to the environment. Following the acclimation period mice are weighed and given either the compound of interest administered i.p. or p.o., or the appropriate volume of vehicle (10 % Tween- 80) as control. Fifteen minutes after the i.p.
  • Compounds can be tested for their potential to treat chronic pain (i.e., antiallodynic and antihyperalgesic activities) using the Chung model of peripheral neuropathy (Kim and Chung, Pain 50: 355-363 (1992)).
  • Male Sprague-Dawley rats weighing between 200-225 g are anesthetized with halothane (1-3 % in a mixture of 70 % air and 30 % oxygen), and their body temperature controlled during anesthesia through use of a homeothermic blanket.
  • a 2-cm dorsal midline incision is then made at the L5 and L6 level, and the para-vertebral muscle groups retracted bilaterally.
  • L5 and L6 spinal nerves are then exposed, isolated, and tightly ligated with 6-0 or 7-0 silk suture.
  • a sham operation is performed exposing the contralateral L5 and L6 spinal nerves, without ligating, as a negative control.
  • Tactile Allodynia Sensitivity to non-noxious mechanical stimuli can be measured in animals to assess tactile allodynia. Rats are transferred to an elevated testing cage with a wire mesh floor and allowed to acclimate for five to ten minutes. A series of von Frey monofilaments are applied to the plantar surface of the hindpaw to determine the animal's withdrawal threshold. The first filament used possesses a buckling weight of 9.1 gms (.96 log value) and is applied up to five times to see if it elicits a withdrawal response. If the animal has a withdrawal response, then the next lightest filament in the series would be applied up to five times to determine if it also could elicit a response.
  • PWT can be measured only in the injured paw, or in both the injured and non-injured paw.
  • mechanical hyperalgesia associated with nerve injuty induced pain can be assessed in rats. Rats are tested prior to surgery to determine a baseline, or normal, PWT. Rats are tested again 2 to 3 weeks post-surgery, prior to, and at different times after (e.g. 1, 3, 5 and 24 hr) drug administration. An increase in PWT following drug administration indicates that the test compound reduces mechanical hyperalgesia.
  • a compound of the present invention may be administered to a mammal in the form of a raw chemical without any other components present, the compound is preferably administered as part of a pharmaceutical composition containing the compound combined with a suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carrier can be selected from pharmaceutically acceptable excipients and auxiliaries.
  • compositions within the scope of the present invention include all compositions where a compound of the present invention is combined with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the compound is present in the composition in an amount that is effective to achieve its intended therapeutic purpose. While individual needs may vary, a determination of optimal ranges of effective amounts of each compound is within the skill of the art.
  • the compounds may be administered to a mammal, e.g., a human, orally at a dose of from about 0.0025 to about 1500 mg per kg body weight of the mammal, or an equivalent amount of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof, per day to treat, prevent or ameliorate the particular disorder.
  • a useful oral dose of a compound of the present invention administered to a mammal is from about 0.0025 to about 50 mg per kg body weight of the mammal, or an equivalent amount of the pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
  • the dose is typically about one-half of the oral dose.
  • a unit oral dose may comprise from about 0.01 to about 50 mg, and preferably about 0.1 to about 10 mg, of the compound.
  • the unit dose can be administered one or more times daily, e.g., as one or more tablets or capsules, each containing from about 0.01 to about 50 mg of the compound, or an equivalent amount of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or solvate thereof.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered to any animal that may experience the beneficial effects of a compound of the present invention.
  • animals e.g., humans and companion animals, although the invention is not intended to be so limited.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by any means that achieves its intended purpose.
  • administration can be by the oral, parenteral, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, transdermal, intranasal, transmucosal, rectal, intravaginal or buccal route, or by inhalation.
  • the dosage administered and route of administration will vary, depending upon the circumstances of the particular subject, and taking into account such factors as age, health, and weight of the recipient, condition or disorder to be treated, kind of concurrent treatment, if any, frequency of treatment, and the nature of the effect desired.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered orally and is formulated into tablets, dragees, capsules or an oral liquid preparation.
  • the oral formulation comprises extruded multiparticulates comprising the compound of the invention.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered rectally, and is formulated in suppositories.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by injection.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered transdermally.
  • composition of the present invention can be administered by inhalation or by intranasal or transmucosal administration.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by the intravaginal route.
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can contain from about 0.01 to 99 percent by weight, and preferably from about 0.25 to 75 percent by weight, of active compound(s).
  • a method of the present invention such as a method for treating, preventing, or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels in an animal in need thereof, can further comprise administering a second therapeutic agent to the animal in combination with a compound of the present invention.
  • the other therapeutic agent is administered in an effective amount.
  • a compound of the present invention i.e., the first therapeutic agent
  • the second therapeutic agent can act additively or, in one embodiment, synergistically.
  • a compound of the present invention is administered concurrently with a second therapeutic agent; for example, a single composition comprising both an effective amount of a compound of any of Formulae I-XIII, and an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent can be administered.
  • the present invention further provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a combination of a compound of the present invention, the second therapeutic agent, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a first pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of a compound of any of Formulae I-XIII and a second pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent can be concurrently administered.
  • an effective amount of a compound of the present invention is administered prior or subsequent to administration of an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent.
  • the compound of the present invention is administered while the second therapeutic agent exerts its therapeutic effect, or the second therapeutic agent is administered while the compound of the present invention exerts its therapeutic effect for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder or condition.
  • the second therapeutic agent can be an opioid agonist, a non-opioid analgesic, a non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agent, an antimigraine agent, a Cox-II inhibitor, a ⁇ -adrenergic blocker, an anticonvulsant, an antidepressant, an anticancer agent, an agent for treating addictive disorder, an agent for treating Parkinson's disease and parkinsonism, an agent for treating anxiety, an agent for treating epilepsy, an agent for treating a seizure, an agent for treating a stroke, an agent for treating a pruritic condition, an agent for treating psychosis, an agent for treating ALS, an agent for treating a cognitive disorder, an agent for treating a migraine, an agent for treating vomiting, an agent for treating dyskinesia, or an agent for treating depression, or a mixture thereof.
  • Examples of useful opioid agonists include, but are not limited to, alfentanil, allylprodine, alphaprodine, anileridine, benzylmorphine, bezitramide, buprenorphine, butorphanol, clonitazene, codeine, desomorphine, dextromoramide, dezocine, diampromide, diamorphone, dihydrocodeine, dihydromorphine, dimenoxadol, dimepheptanol, dimethylthiambutene, dioxaphetyl butyrate, dipipanone, eptazocine, ethoheptazine, ethylmethylthiambutene, ethylmorphine, etonitazene, fentanyl, heroin, hydrocodone, hydromorphone, hydroxypethidine, isomethadone, ketobemidone, levorphanol, levophenacylmorphan, l
  • the opioid agonist is selected from codeine, hydromorphone, hydrocodone, oxycodone, dihydrocodeine, dihydromorphine, morphine, tramadol, oxymorphone, pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, and mixtures thereof.
  • non-opioid analgesics include non-steroidal antiinflammatory agents, such as aspirin, ibuprofen, diclofenac, naproxen, benoxaprofen, flurbiprofen, fenoprofen, flubufen, ketoprofen, indoprofen, piroprofen, carprofen, oxaprozin, pramoprofen, muroprofen, trioxaprofen, suprofen, aminoprofen, tiaprofenic acid, fluprofen, bucloxic acid, indomethacin, sulindac, tolmetin, zomepirac, tiopinac, zidometacin, acemetacin, fentiazac, clidanac, oxpinac, mefenamic acid, meclofenamic acid, flufenamic acid, niflumic acid, tolfen
  • non-opioid analgesics include the following, non limiting, chemical classes of analgesic, antipyretic, nonsteroidal antiinflammatory drugs: salicylic acid derivatives, including aspirin, sodium salicylate, choline magnesium trisalicylate, salsalate, difiunisal, salicylsalicylic acid, sulfasalazine, and olsalazin; para aminophennol derivatives including acetaminophen and phenacetin; indole and indene acetic acids, including indomethacin, sulindac, and etodolac; heteroaryl acetic acids, including tolmetin, diclofenac, and ketorolac; anthranilic acids (fenamates), including mefenamic acid, and meclofenamic acid; enolic acids, including oxicams (piroxicam, tenoxicam), and pyrazolidinediones (phenyl
  • Cox- II inhibitors and 5 -lipoxygenase inhibitors, as well as combinations thereof, are described in U.S. Patent No. 6,136,839, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • useful Cox II inhibitors include, but are not limited to, rofecoxib and celecoxib.
  • Examples of useful antimigraine agents include, but are not limited to, alpiropride, bromocriptine, dihydroergotamine, dolasetron, ergocornine, ergocorninine, ergocryptine, ergonovine, ergot, ergotamine, fiumedroxone acetate, fonazine, ketanserin, lisuride, lomerizine, methylergonovine, methysergide, metoprolol, naratriptan, oxetorone, pizotyline, propranolol, risperidone, rizatriptan, sumatriptan, timolol, trazodone, zolmitriptan, and mixtures thereof.
  • Examples of useful ⁇ -adrenergic blockers include, but are not limited to, acebutolol, alprenolol, amosulabol, arotinolol, atenolol, befunolol, betaxolol, bevantolol, bisoprolol, bopindolol, bucumolol, bufetolol, bufuralol, bunitrolol, bupranolol, butidrine hydrochloride, butofilolol, carazolol, carteolol, carvedilol, celiprolol, cetamolol, cloranolol, dilevalol, epanolol, esmolol, indenolol, labetalol, levobunolol, mepindolol, metipranolol, metoprolol
  • Examples of useful anticonvulsants include, but are not limited to, acetylpheneturide, albutoin, aloxidone, aminoglutethimide, 4-amino-3- hydroxybutyric acid, atrolactamide, beclamide, buramate, calcium bromide, carbamazepine, cinromide, clomethiazole, clonazepam, decimemide, diethadione, dimethadione, doxenitroin, eterobarb, ethadione, ethosuximide, ethotoin, felbamate, fluoresone, gabapentin, 5-hydroxytryptophan, lamotrigine, magnesium bromide, magnesium sulfate, mephenytoin, mephobarbital, metharbital, methetoin, methsuximide, 5-methyl-5-(3- phenanthryl)-hydantoin, 3 -methyl-5 -phenylhydan
  • Examples of useful antidepressants include, but are not limited to, binedaline, caroxazone, citalopram, (S)-citalopram, dimethazan, fencamine, indalpine, indeloxazine hydrocholoride, nefopam, nomifensine, oxitriptan, oxypertine, paroxetine, sertraline, thiazesim, trazodone, benmoxine, iproclozide, iproniazid, isocarboxazid, nialamide, octamoxin, phenelzine, cotinine, rolicyprine, rolipram, maprotiline, metralindole, mianserin, mirtazepine, adinazolam, amitriptyline, amitriptylinoxide, amoxapine, butriptyline, clomipramine, demexip
  • Examples of useful anticancer agents include, but are not limited to, acivicin, aclarubicin, acodazole hydrochloride, acronine, adozelesin, aldesleukin, altretamine, ambomycin, ametantrone acetate, aminoglutethimide, amsacrine, anastrozole, anthramycin, asparaginase, asperlin, azacitidine, azetepa, azotomycin, batimastat, benzodepa, bicalutamide, bisantrene hydrochloride, bisnafide dimesylate, bizelesin, bleomycin sulfate, brequinar sodium, bropirimine, busulfan, cactinomycin, calusterone, caracemide, carbetimer, carboplatin, carmustine, carubicin hydrochloride, carzelesin, cedefingol, chloram
  • Therapeutic agents useful for treating or preventing an addictive disorder include, but are not limited to, methadone, desipramine, amantadine, fluoxetine, buprenorphine, an opiate agonist, 3-phenoxypyridine, or a serotonin antagonist.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing Parkinson's disease and parkinsonism include, but are not limited to, carbidopa/levodopa, pergolide, bromocriptine, ropinirole, pramipexole, entacapone, tolcapone, selegiline, amantadine, and trihexyphenidyl hydrochloride.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing anxiety include, but are not limited to, benzodiazepines, such as alprazolam, brotizolam, chlordiazepoxide, clobazam, clonazepam, clorazepate, demoxepam, diazepam, estazolam, flumazenil, flurazepam, halazepam, lorazepam, midazolam, nitrazepam, nordazepam, oxazepam, prazepam, quazepam, temazepam, and triazolam; non-benzodiazepine agents, such as buspirone, gepirone, ipsapirone, tiospirone, zolpicone, Zolpidem, and zaleplon; tranquilizers, such as barbituates, e.g., amobarbital, aprobarbital, butabarbital, butalbit
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing epilepsy or seizure include, but are not limited to, carbamazepine, ethosuximide, gabapentin, lamotrigine, phenobarbital, phenytoin, primidone, valproic acid, trimethadione, benzodiazepines, gamma-vinyl GABA, acetazolamide, and felbamate.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing stroke include, but are not limited to, anticoagulants such as heparin, agents that break up clots such as streptokinase or tissue plasminogen activator, agents that reduce swelling such as mannitol or corticosteroids, and acetylsalicylic acid.
  • anticoagulants such as heparin
  • agents that break up clots such as streptokinase or tissue plasminogen activator
  • agents that reduce swelling such as mannitol or corticosteroids
  • acetylsalicylic acid acetylsalicylic acid
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing a pruritic condition include, but are not limited to, naltrexone; nalmefene; danazol; tricyclics such as amitriptyline, imipramine, and doxepin; antidepressants such as those given below; menthol; camphor; phenol; pramoxine; capsaicin; tar; steroids; and antihistamines.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing psychosis include, but are not limited to, phenothiazines such as chlorpromazine hydrochloride, mesoridazine besylate, and thoridazine hydrochloride; thioxanthenes such as chloroprothixene and thiothixene hydrochloride; clozapine; risperidone; olanzapine; quetiapine; quetiapine fumarate; haloperidol; haloperidol decanoate; loxapine succinate; molindone hydrochloride; pimozide; and ziprasidone.
  • phenothiazines such as chlorpromazine hydrochloride, mesoridazine besylate, and thoridazine hydrochloride
  • thioxanthenes such as chloroprothixene and thiothixene hydrochloride
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing ALS include, but are not limited to, baclofen, neurotrophic factors, riluzole, tizanidine, benzodiazepines such as clonazepan and dantrolene.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing cognitive disorders include, but are not limited to, agents for treating or preventing dementia such as tacrine; donepezil; ibuprofen; antipsychotic drugs such as thioridazine and haloperidol; and antidepressant drugs such as those given below.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing a migraine include, but are not limited to, sumatriptan; methysergide; ergotamine; caffeine; and beta-blockers such as propranolol, verapamil, and divalproex.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing vomiting include, but are not limited to, 5-HT3 receptor antagonists such as ondansetron, dolasetron, granisetron, and tropisetron; dopamine receptor antagonists such as prochlorperazine, thiethylperazine, chlorpromazine, metoclopramide, and domperidone; glucocorticoids such as dexamethasone; and benzodiazepines such as lorazepam and alprazolam.
  • 5-HT3 receptor antagonists such as ondansetron, dolasetron, granisetron, and tropisetron
  • dopamine receptor antagonists such as prochlorperazine, thiethylperazine, chlorpromazine, metoclopramide, and domperidone
  • glucocorticoids such as dexamethasone
  • benzodiazepines such as lorazepam and alprazolam.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing dyskinesia include, but are not limited to, reserpine and tetrabenazine.
  • Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing depression include, but are not limited to, tricyclic antidepressants such as amitryptyline, amoxapine, bupropion, clomipramine, desipramine, doxepin, imipramine, maprotiline, nefazadone, nortriptyline, protriptyline, trazodone, trimipramine, and venlafaxine; selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors such as citalopram, (S)-citalopram, fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, paroxetine, and setraline; monoamine oxidase inhibitors such as isocarboxazid, pargyline, phenelzine, and tranylcypromine; and psychostimulants such as dextroamphetamine and methylphenidate.
  • tricyclic antidepressants such as amitryptyline, amoxapine, bupropion, clomipra
  • a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention is preferably manufactured in a manner which itself will be known in view of the instant disclosure, for example, by means of conventional mixing, granulating, dragee-making, dissolving, extrusion, or lyophilizing processes.
  • pharmaceutical compositions for oral use can be obtained by combining the active compound with solid excipients, optionally grinding the resulting mixture and processing the mixture of granules, after adding suitable auxiliaries, if desired or necessary, to obtain tablets or dragee cores.
  • Suitable excipients include fillers such as saccharides (for example, lactose, sucrose, mannitol or sorbitol), cellulose preparations, calcium phosphates (for example, tricalcium phosphate or calcium hydrogen phosphate), as well as binders such as starch paste (using, for example, maize starch, wheat starch, rice starch, or potato starch), gelatin, tragacanth, methyl cellulose, hydroxypropylmethylcellulose, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, and/or polyvinyl pyrrolidone.
  • saccharides for example, lactose, sucrose, mannitol or sorbitol
  • cellulose preparations for example, calcium phosphates (for example, tricalcium phosphate or calcium hydrogen phosphate)
  • binders such as starch paste (using, for example, maize starch, wheat starch, rice starch, or potato starch), gelatin, tragacanth, methyl cellulose, hydroxypropylmethyl
  • one or more disintegrating agents can be added, such as the above-mentioned starches and also carboxymethyl- starch, cross-linked polyvinyl pyrrolidone, agar, or alginic acid or a salt thereof, such as sodium alginate.
  • Auxiliaries are typically flow-regulating agents and lubricants such as, for example, silica, talc, stearic acid or salts thereof (e.g., magnesium stearate or calcium stearate), and polyethylene glycol.
  • Dragee cores are provided with suitable coatings that are resistant to gastric juices.
  • concentrated saccharide solutions may be used, which may optionally contain gum arabic, talc, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, polyethylene glycol and/or titanium dioxide, lacquer solutions and suitable organic solvents or solvent mixtures.
  • cellulose preparations such as acetylcellulose phthalate or hydroxypropymethyl-cellulose phthalate
  • Dye stuffs or pigments may be added to the tablets or dragee coatings, for example, for identification or in order to characterize combinations of active compound doses.
  • Examples of other pharmaceutical preparations that can be used orally include push-fit capsules made of gelatin, or soft, sealed capsules made of gelatin and a plasticizer such as glycerol or sorbitol.
  • the push-fit capsules can contain a compound in the form of granules, which may be mixed with fillers such as lactose, binders such as starches, and/or lubricants such as talc or magnesium stearate and, optionally, stabilizers, or in the form of extruded multiparticulates.
  • the active compounds are preferably dissolved or suspended in suitable liquids, such as fatty oils or liquid paraffin.
  • stabilizers may be added.
  • Possible pharmaceutical preparations for rectal administration include, for example, suppositories, which consist of a combination of one or more active compounds with a suppository base.
  • Suitable suppository bases include natural and synthetic triglycerides, and paraffin hydrocarbons, among others. It is also possible to use gelatin rectal capsules consisting of a combination of active compound with a base material such as, for example, a liquid triglyceride, polyethylene glycol, or paraffin hydrocarbon.
  • Suitable formulations for parenteral administration include aqueous solutions of the active compound in a water-soluble form such as, for example, a water-soluble salt, alkaline solution, or acidic solution.
  • a suspension of the active compound may be prepared as an oily suspension.
  • Suitable lipophilic solvents or vehicles for such as suspension may include fatty oils (for example, sesame oil), synthetic fatty acid esters (for example, ethyl oleate), triglycerides, or a polyethylene glycol such as polyethylene glycol-400 (PEG-400).
  • An aqueous suspension may contain one or more substances to increase the viscosity of the suspension, including, for example, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, sorbitol, and/or dextran.
  • the suspension may optionally contain stabilizers.
  • N-Cyclopropyl-N-piperidin-S-yl-S- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide hydrochloride (6) was prepared as follows. NaB(O 2 CCHs) 3 H (14 g, 66 mmol, Aldrich) was added to a mixture of N-tert-butoxycarbonylpiperidine-3-one (1) (10 g, 50 mmol, Aldrich), aminocyclopropyl (2) (3 g, 52.5 mmol, Aldrich), molecular sieves (4A beads, 20 g, Aldrich) in dichloroethane (DCE, 200 mL) at 0 0 C. The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 hours.
  • DCE dichloroethane
  • (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N- ⁇ 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methyl- pentanoyl]piperidin-3-yl ⁇ -3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (16) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 8 as prepared in Example 2 (lOOmg, 0.22 mmol), compound 15 (18 mg, 0.22 mmol, Aldrich) and 4A molecular sieves (500 mg) in 2 mL of 1 ,2-dichloroethane (DCE) was shaken at room temperature for 10 minutes, and then NaB(OAc) 3 H (43 mg, 0.22 mmol) was charged.
  • DCE 1 ,2-dichloroethane
  • N-(4-Fluorophenyl)-2-[3-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonylamino)- pyrrolidin-l-yl]acetamide (25) was prepared as follows. A mixture of compound 21 (1.0 g, 5.4 mmol, Aldrich), compound 22 (1 g, 5.4 mmol, Oakwood), and K 2 CO 3 (1 g, 7.3 mmol) in 10 mL of CH 3 CN was shaken at room temperature for 48 hours.
  • reaction mixture was poured on to a column (silica gel, 20 g) and washed with EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to give the title compound 25 as a sticky oil, which was converted to its HCl-salt by dissolving in 0.5 mL of dioxane and then treating with 4N HCl in 1,4- dioxane. The solvent was removed and the salt was dried under vacuum at 50 0 C for 24 hours (0.15 g, yield 48%).
  • N-(I- ⁇ 3-[Bis-(4-fluorophenyl)amino]propyl ⁇ piperidin-3-yl)-N- isopropyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (27) was prepared by shaking a mixture of compound 6 (0.2 g, 0.5 mmol), compound 26 (150 mg, 0.44 mmol), TEA (0.2 mL) and K 2 CO 3 (1 g, 7.2 mmol) in CH 3 CN (2 mL) at 70 0 C for 16 hours.
  • N-Cyclopropyl-N- ⁇ 1 -[3-(2-methoxyethylamino)propionyl]piperidin- 3-yl ⁇ -3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (37) (90 mg, 38%, white solid): 1 H NMR (400 MHz, CD 3 OD): 5 8.18 - 8.21 (m, IH), 8.12 - 8.15 (m, IH), 8.01 - 8.06 (m, IH), 7.86 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.48 - 4.54 (m, IH), 3.81 - 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.65 - 3.71 (m, 2H), 3.43 - 3.47 (m, 3H), 3.25 - 3.32 (m, 4H), 2.94 - 3.02 (m, 0.5H), 2.82 - 2.90 (m, 3H), 2.48 - 2.57 (m, 0.5H), 1.95 - 2.11 (m, 2H), 1.42 - 1.
  • N-Cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-isobutylaminoacetyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide (41) was prepared as follows. Compound 39 (0.6 g, 5.4 mmol, Aldrich) was added to a solution of compound 6 (1.5 g, 3.9 mmol) and TEA (2 mL) in DCM (20 mL) at room temperature over 10 minutes. The reaction was then quenched with water (4 mL) and the organic layer was separated, concentrated and purified by column (silica gel, EtAOc/hexanes 1/1) to give compound 40 as a colorless oil (1.2 g, 70%).
  • La 2-Chloro-N-isobutyl-acetamide (prepared as shown below);
  • Lb 2- Chloro-N-(4-fluorophenyl)-acetamide (Oakwood)
  • Compound 40 was prepared as shown in Example 12.
  • Compound 44 was prepared as follows. A mixture of compound 40 (100 mg, 0.24 mmol), 4-methoxy-benzylamine (ie, Aldich, 70 mg, 2.0 eq.) and TEA (1 mL) in DMF (1 mL) was shaken at 75 0 C for 10 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was purified by column (silica gel, DMC/MeOH 100/15) to give the title compound 44 as a free base (yield 70%, white solid).
  • N-Cyclopropyl-N-(l- ⁇ 2-[(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)amino]acetyl ⁇ - piperidin-3-yl)-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (45) was prepared accordingly using 3-(aminomethyl)pyridine (if, Aldrich). The title compound 45 was obtained as a free base (yield 40%, white solid).
  • N-type calcium channel (NTCC) blockers N-type calcium channel (NTCC) blockers
  • LTCC L-type calcium channel

Abstract

The invention relates to azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and hexahydroazepinyl compounds of Formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, or solvates thereof, wherein R1-R3 and Z are defined as set forth in the specification. The invention is also directed to the use compounds of Formula I to treat, prevent or ameliorate a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels, and particularly N-type calcium channels. Compounds of the present invention are especially useful for treating pain.

Description

BENZENESULFONAMIDE COMPOUNDS AND THEIR USE
Background of the Invention
Field of the Invention
[0001] This invention is in the field of medicinal chemistry. The invention relates to novel azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and hexahydroazepinyl compounds and the discovery that these compounds act as blockers of calcium (Ca +) channels.
Background Art
[0002] Calcium ions play fundamental roles in the regulation of many cellular processes. It is therefore essential that their intracellular levels be maintained under strict, yet dynamic control (Davila, H. M., Annals of the
New York Academy of Sciences, pp. 102-117 (1999)). Voltage-gated calcium channels (VGCC) serve as one of the important mechanisms for fast calcium influx into the cell. Calcium channels are hetero-oligomeric proteins consisting of a pore-forming subunit (αl), which is able to form functional channels on its own in heterologous expression systems, and a set of auxiliary or regulatory subunits. Calcium channels have been classified based on their pharmacological and/or electrophysiological properties. The classification of voltage-gated calcium channels divides them into three groups: (i) high voltage-activated (HVA) channels, which include L-, N-, P-, and Q-types; (ii) intermediate (IVA) voltage-activated R-type channels; and (iii) low voltage-activated (LVA) T-type channels (Davila, supra). Voltage- gated calcium channels (VGCC) are also known as voltage-dependent calcium channels (VDCC) or voltage-sensitive calcium channels (VSCC). [0003] Voltage-sensitive calcium channels (VSCC) regulate intracellular calcium concentration, which affects various important neuronal functions such as cellular excitability, neurotransmitter release, hormone secretion, intracellular metabolism, neurosecretory activity and gene expression (Hu et al, Bioorganic & Medicinal Chemistry 8: 1203-1212 (2000)). N-type channels are found mainly in central and peripheral neurons, being primarily located on presynaptic nerve terminals. These channels regulate the calcium flux required for depolarization-evoked release of a transmitter from synaptic endings. The transmission of pain signals from the periphery to the central nervous system (CNS) is mediated by N-type calcium channels located in the spinal cord (Song et al., J. Med. Chem. 43:3474-3477 (2000)).
[0004] The six types of calcium channels (i.e., L, N, P, Q, R, and T) are expressed throughout the nervous system (Wallace, M. S., The Clinical Journal of Pain 76:580-585 (2000)). Voltage-sensitive calcium channels of the N-type exist in the superficial laminae of the dorsal horn and are thought to modulate nociceptive processing by a central mechanism. Blockade of the N-type calcium channel in the superficial dorsal horn modulates membrane excitability and inhibits neurotransmitter release, resulting in pain relief. Wallace (supra) suggests that based on animal models, N-type calcium channel antagonists have a greater analgesic potency than sodium channel antagonists.
[0005] N-type calcium channel blockers have usefulness for neuroprotection and analgesia. Ziconotide, which is a selective N-type calcium channel blocker, has been found to have analgesic activity in animal models and neuroprotective activity in focal and global ischemia models (Song et al., supra). Examples of known calcium channel blockers include flunarizine, fiuspirilene, cilnipide, PD 157767, SB-201823, SB-206284, NNC09-0026, and PD 151307 (Hu et al., supra). [0006] Blockade of N-type channels can prevent and/or attenuate subjective pain as well as primary and/or secondary hyperalgesia and allodynia in a variety of experimental and clinical conditions (Vanegas, H. et al., Pain 85:9- 18 (2000)). N-type voltage-gated calcium channels (VGCC) play a major role in the release of synaptic mediators such as glutamate, acetylcholine, dopamine, norepinephrine, gamma-aminobutyric acid (GABA) and calcitonin gene-related peptide (CGRP).
[0007] Inhibition of voltage-gated L-type calcium channels has been shown to be beneficial for neuroprotection (Song et al., supra). However, inhibition of cardiac L-type calcium channels can lead to hypotension. It is believed that a rapid and profound lowering of arterial pressure tends to counteract the neuroprotective effects of L-type calcium channel blockers. A need exists for antagonists that are selective for N-type calcium channels over L-type calcium channels to avoid potential hypotensive effects.
[0008] Published PCT Application No. WO 02/28346 by Odile et al. describes N- { 1 -[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-azetidinyl} -4-fluoro-N- methylbenzene-sulfonamide and N- { 1 -[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3- azetidinyl}-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide as CBl receptor antagonists.
[0009] U.S. Patent No. 6,262,046 to Alker et al. describes 1-diphenylmethyl- 3-(N-methylbenzenesulfonamido)azetidine as an intermediate.
[0010] U.S. Patent No. 6,734,176 to Achard et al. describes pharmaceutical compositions containing 3-aminoazetidine derivatives useful as CBl -receptor antagonists.
[0011] United States Patent Application Publication No. US 2004/00224901 by Chaturvedula et al. describes N- { 1 -[(2R)-2-amino-3-(4- chlorophenyl)propionyl]-(3S)-pyrrolidin-3-yl}-N-cyclohexyl-benzene- sulfonamide and [2-[(3S)-3-(benzenesulfonyl-cyclohexylamino)pyrrolidin-l- yl]-(lR)-(4-chlorobenzyl)-2-oxo-ethyl]carbamic acid tert-butyl ester as intermediates.
[0012] United States Patent Application Publication No. US 2005/245573 by Neitzel et al. describes 4-chloro-N-ethyl-N-[l-(phenylmethyl)-3- pyrrolidinyljbenzenesulfonamide useful in the treatment of or prevention of congnitive disorders, such as Alzheimer's disease.
Brief Summary of the Invention
[0013] The present invention is related to the use of azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and hexahydroazepinyl compounds represented by Formula I, below, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, as blockers of calcium (Ca +) channels. Certain compounds of Formula I show selectivity as N-type calcium channel blockers.
[0014] The invention is also related to treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels in a mammal suffering from excess activity of said channels by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, as described herein. Specifically, the invention is related to treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of N-type calcium channels in a mammal suffering from excess activity of said channels by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, as described herein.
[0015] A number of compounds useful in the present invention have not been heretofore reported. Thus, one aspect of the present invention is directed to novel compounds of Formula I, as well as their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates.
[0016] Another aspect of the present invention is directed to the use of the novel compounds of Formula I, and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates, as blockers of N-type calcium channels.
[0017] A further aspect of the present invention is to provide a method for treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain (e.g., acute pain, chronic pain, which includes but is not limited to neuropathic pain and inflammatory pain, or surgical pain), migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (e.g., Alzheimer's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), or Parkinson's disease), depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia, by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration.
[0018] A further aspect of the present invention is to provide a pharmaceutical composition useful for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium ion channels, especially N- type calcium ion channels, said pharmaceutical composition containing an effective amount of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in a mixture with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
[0019] Also, an aspect of the invention is to provide a method of modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in a mammal, wherein said method comprises administering to the mammal an effective amount of at least one compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof. [0020] A further aspect of the present invention is to provide radiolabeled compounds of Formula I and the use of such compounds, or their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs or solvates, as radioligands for their binding site on the calcium channel.
[0021] A further aspect of the invention is to provide a method for screening a candidate compound for the ability to bind to a receptor using a 3H, 11C, or 14C radiolabeled compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof. This method comprises a) introducing a fixed concentration of the radiolabeled compound to the receptor to form a mixture; b) titrating the mixture with a candidate compound; and c) determining the binding of the candidate compound to said receptor.
[0022] A further aspect of the invention is to provide the use of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder, depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia in a mammal. In a preferred embodiment, the invention provides the use of a compound of Formula I, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating acute pain, chronic pain, or surgical pain.
[0023] Additional embodiments and advantages of the invention will be set forth in part in the description that follows, and will flow from the description, or may be learned by practice of the invention. The embodiments and advantages of the invention will be realized and attained by means of the elements and combinations particularly pointed out in the appended claims. [0024] It is to be understood that both the foregoing summary and the following detailed description are exemplary and explanatory only and are not restrictive of the invention, as claimed.
Detailed Description of the Invention
[0025] One aspect of the present invention is based on the use of compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, as blockers of Ca + channels. In view of this property, compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, are useful for treating disorders responsive to the blockade of calcium ion channels. In one aspect, compounds of Formula I, and the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, selectively block N-type calcium ion channels and, thus, are useful for treating disorders responsive to the selective blockade of N-type calcium ion channels.
[0026] The compounds useful in this aspect of the invention are compounds represented by Formula I:
Figure imgf000008_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0027] R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
[0028] R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
[0029] Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein: Z1 is
Figure imgf000009_0001
Z2 is
Figure imgf000009_0002
Z3 is :R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14
Z4 Is
-so, »15 and
Z5 is
,30
/
CH \ »31
[0030] provided that Z is Z1, Z2 or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen;
[0031] R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or [0032] R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and
[0033] R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein
[0034] R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or [0035] R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
[0036] R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy;
[0037] provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
[0038] R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
[0039] R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring; or
[0040] R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; [0041] R32 and R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
[0042] R33 is hydrogen and R32 is as defined above; or
[0043] R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
[0044] R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6, and R7 are each independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl;
[0045] R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0;
[0046] R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
[0047] R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy;
[0048] R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
[0049] R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
[0050] A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent (a covalent bond), and B is CH or N, or
[0051] A-B is CH=C;
[0052] D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent (a covalent bond);
[0053] x is 0 or 1;
[0054] y is O or 1;
[0055] m is 0, 1, 2, or 3;
[0056] n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5;
[0057] p is O, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and
[0058] q is 0, 1, 2, or 3.
[0059] In compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1, the carbon to which the -NR4R5 group is attached can be a chiral center. The carbon at the 3 -position of the azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidine, and hexahydroazepine ring, i.e., the carbon where the benzenesulfonamide group is attached, can also be a chiral center. Accordingly, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
[0060] The groups R10-R13, when they are not equal to H, each take the place of a hydrogen atom that would otherwise be present in any position on the phenyl ring to which the particular R group is attached. Similarly, optional substituents attached to aryl, phenyl, and heteroaryl rings each take the place of a hydrogen atom that would otherwise be present in any position on the aryl or heteroaryl rings.
[0061] One group of compounds useful in this aspect of the present invention are compounds of Formula I as defined above, but with the following provisos:
[0062] 1) when Z is Z1, q is 1, m and y are 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4 -R6 are each hydrogen, and R7 is benzyl substituted with chlorine at the para- position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen;
[0063] 2) when Z is Z3, q is 1, D is absent, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and p is 0, then R14 is not an unsubstituted phenyl;
[0064] 3) when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl; or
[0065] 4) when Z is Z1, q is 1, m and y are 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4 and R6 are each hydrogen, R5 is alkoxycarbonyl, and R7 is benzyl substituted with chlorine at the para-position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen.
[0066] In one aspect, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of Formula I:
Figure imgf000019_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvate thereof, wherein:
[0067] R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
[0068] R3 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3- tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, and aminocarbonylalkyl;
[0069] Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000019_0002
Z is
Figure imgf000020_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 Is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000020_0002
[0070] R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
[0071] R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein
[0072] R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or [0073] R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
[0074] R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and benzyloxyalkyl; or
[0075] R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17 or O, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
[0076] R7 is hydrogen, R4 is hydrogen or alkyl, and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group;
[0077] R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0;
[0078] R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
[0079] R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
[0080] R15 is phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino;
[0081] R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
[0082] A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or
[0083] A-B is CH=C;
[0084] D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent, provided that D is other than -NH- or -N(alkyl)- when R14 is -NR14aR14b;
[0085] m is 0, 1, 2 or 3;
[0086] n is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5;
[0087] p is O, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and
[0088] q is O, 1, 2, or 3;
[0089] with the proviso that when Z is Z1, q and m are 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4 -R6 are each hydrogen, and R7 is phenyl substituted with chlorine at the para-position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen.
[0090] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds represented by Formula II:
Figure imgf000026_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, and solvates thereof, wherein R1, R2, Z, and q are as defined above.
[0091] In one aspect, preferred compounds falling within the scope of Formula II include those represented by Formula III:
Figure imgf000026_0002
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, and solvates thereof, wherein Z and q are as defined above.
[0092] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 0 (azetidinyl).
[0093] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 1 (pyrrolidinyl). [0094] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 2 (piperidinyl).
[0095] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where q is 3 (hexahydroazepinyl).
[0096] Preferably, in compounds of Formulae I and II, R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and nitro. More preferably, R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci-6 alkyl, halo(Ci. ό)alkyl, cyano, C1-6 alkoxy, halo(Ci-6)alkoxy, amino, Ci-6 alkylamino, di(Ci_ 6)alkylamino, and nitro; and more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci-3 alkyl, halo(Ci-3)alkyl, cyano, Ci-3 alkoxy, halo(Ci-3)alkoxy, and nitro. Advantageously, R1 and R2 are independently hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, fluoromethyl, cyano, nitro, methoxy or difiuoromethoxy. More preferably, R1 is hydrogen and R2 is trifluoromethyl, or both R1 and R2 are hydrogen. Preferably, R2 is in the meta-position of the phenyl ring.
[0097] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are those where R3 is alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, or alkoxycarbonylalkyl. Preferably, R3 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, 3- tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl and aminocarbonylalkyl; more preferably selected from Ci-6 alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl(Ci- 3)alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl(d-3)alkyl, Ci-3 alkoxy(Ci.6)alkyl, hydroxy(Ci.6)alkyl, Ci-3 alkylsulfonylamino(Ci-3)alkyl, and aminocarbonyl(Ci-3)alkyl. Advantageously, R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl. More advantageously, R3 is cyclopropyl, methyl, iso-propyl, or iso-butyl, especially cyclopropyl.
[0098] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z1, and R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy,
[0099] provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen . [0100] Useful compounds include those where R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, unsubstituted phenyl, and phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, Ci-6 alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_6)alkyl, amino(Ci-6)alkyl, C1-6 alkylamino(Ci-6)alkyl, di(Ci_ 6)alkylamino(Ci-6)alkyl, unsubstituted phenyl, and phenyl susbtituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, Ci-3 alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_3)alkyl, unsubstituted phenyl, and phenyl optionally susbtituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, isobutyl, isopentyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, and unsubstituted phenyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring selected from the group consisting of oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, 4-methylpiperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, and tetrahydropyridyl. Advantageously, R4 and R5 are independently hydrogen, methyl or hydroxyethyl, or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form 1 -pyrrolidinyl, 4-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or 4-methylpiperazinyl.
[0101] In one embodiment, useful compounds in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents, preferably one or two substituents, independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; and optionally substituted heteroaryl,
[0102] provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen.
[0103] Useful hydroxyalkyl groups for R5 optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with an optionally substituted aryl or an optionally substituted benzyl include, for example, hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2- hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, 2-hydroxy-l-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-phenylethyl, 2-benzyl-2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxy-l- phenylethyl, l-benzyl-2-hydroxyethyl, and 2-hydroxy-l-phenylpropyl. [0104] Useful alkyl groups for R5 optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo include, for example, C1-6 alkyl optionally substituted with optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, or optionally substituted heterocyclo, such as methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, 1-methylpropyl, Ci-3 alkyl substituted at the 1 -position with optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, such as 2- pyridylmethyl, 3-pyridylmethyl, 2-thienylmethyl, 2-furanylethyl, 4- imidazolylethyl and 1-imidazolylpropyl, or optionally substituted heterocyclo. Useful substituted alkyl groups for R5 include Ci-3 alkyl substituted with unsubstituted cycloalkyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino and dialkylamino; unsubstituted benzyl; unsubstitued benzyloxy; unsubstituted heteroaryl; or unsubstituted heterocyclo.
[0105] Useful optionally substituted heteroaryl groups for R5 include 1-, 2-, or 3-pyridyl, 2-pyrazinyl, and 3-isoxazolyl.
[0106] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R5 is R16-C(O)- wherein R16 is as defined above. Useful compounds include those where R16 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, or phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino. [0107] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R5 is R16-SC>2- where R16 is as defined above. Useful compounds include those where R16 is alkyl, especially methyl; phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and alkylcarbonylamino; or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4- tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl.
[0108] In another embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, where R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl. Useful compounds include those where R5 is, for example, 2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, or 2-hydroxy-l- methylpropyl.
[0109] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z1 and R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
[0110] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z1, and R6 is hydrogen and R7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
[0111] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z1, and R6 is hydrogen and R7 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
[0112] When R6 is hydrogen, R7 is preferably selected from the group consisting of alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and benzyloxyalkyl. More preferably, R7 is selected from the group consisting of straight chain C1-6 alkyl; branched chain C3-6 alkyl; hydroxy(Ci_6)alkyl; C3-6 cycloalkyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of Ci-6 alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci-6)alkyl, and Ci-6 alkoxy; unsubstituted benzyl; benzyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of Ci-6 alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci-6)alkyl, and C1-6 alkoxy; and benzyloxy(Ci-3)alkyl. Advantageously, R7 is methyl; propyl; iso-propyl; butyl; tert-butyl; sec-butyl; iso-butyl; hydroxymethyl; 1- hydroxyethyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, butyl, tert-butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; unsubstituted benzyl; benzyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso- propyl, butyl, tert-butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; 1-benzyloxyethyl; cyclopentyl; cyclohexyl; cyclopentylmethyl; or cyclohexylmethyl.
[0113] In one preferred aspect, when R6 is hydrogen and R7 is alkyl, R4 and R5 together form a 5- or 6-membered heterocycle as described above, or R4 and R5 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl.
[0114] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
[0115] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring.
[0116] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0. Useful compounds include those where R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-6 cycloalkyl ring, which is preferably cyclopentyl or cyclohexyl.
[0117] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring where one or more carbon atoms are replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, preferably replaced with NR17 or O, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring which can be optionally substituted with one or more, prererably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0. Examples of such heterocyclic groups include pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, and piperidinyl.
[0118] In one embodiment, compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring, wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the cycloalkyl ring form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring, such as 6-oxa-bicyclo[3.1.0]hexane. [0119] In one embodiment, compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring, wherein one carbon atom is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring, such as l,4-dioxa-spiro[4.5]decane.
[0120] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge - CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group. Useful compounds include those where R7 is hydrogen, R4 is hydrogen, methyl or ethyl, and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2- CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group. Advantageously, R5 and R6 together form -CH2-CH2-CH2-.
[0121] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1 and x, y, and m are each 0 (zero).
[0122] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1, m is 1, and x and y are each 0.
[0123] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1 and x is 0. [0124] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1 and x is 1.
[0125] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1 and y is 0. [0126] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where Z is Z1 and y is 1.
[0127] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III where y is 1 and R32 and R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or R33 is hydrogen and R32 is as defined above. Useful compounds include those where R32 is hydroxy or alkyl, such as Ci-3 alkyl, and R33 is hydrogen. Useful compounds also include those where R32 and R33 are both alkyl, such as Ci-3 alkyl, and preferably methyl.
[0128] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring, preferably cyclopropyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl.
[0129] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl. Preferably the 4-membered heterocyclic ring is unsubstituted, and R5, R6 and R7 are each hydrogen. [0130] In one embodiment, useful compounds of the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein y is 1 and R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl. Useful compounds include those, where x is 0 or 1, m is 0, 1, 2, or 3, R33 is hydrogen or alkyl, R6 is hydrogen and R7 is hydrogen, alkyl, preferably Ci-3 alkyl, carboxy or alkoxycarbonyl, preferably Ci-4 alkoxycarbonyl, and R5 is hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, preferably Ci-3 hydroxyalkyl, or alkoxycarbonyl, preferably Ci-4 alkoxycarbonyl.
[0131] Suitable heterocyclic rings formed by R32 and R4 include 2- piperidinyl, l-hydroxyethyl-2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl, 1-tert- butoxycarbonyl-2-carboxy-3-piperidinyl, 4-piperidinyl, 1-tert- butoxycarbonyl-2-carboxy-4-piperidinyl, 2-pyrrolidinyl, 1 -hydroxyethyl-2- pyrrolidinyl, 3-pyrrolidinyl, 2-carboxy-4-isopropyl-3-pyrrolidinyl, 3-methyl- 3-pyrrolidinyl, and 4,4-dimethyl-3-pyrrolidinyl.
[0132] Useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 are both hydrogen when Z is Z2, A is CH2 or absent and B is CH. Other useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 form =0 when Z is Z2, A is CH2 or absent and B is CH, or A-B is CH=C. Additional useful compounds include those where Z is Z2, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen and A is O.
[0133] Useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 are both hydrogen when Z is Z2, A is -C(O)- and B is N. [0134] Useful compounds include those where Z is Z2, R8 and R9 together form =0, A is CH2 or absent and B is N.
[0135] Preferably, R10, R11, R12, and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, C1-6 alkyl, Ci-6 alkoxy, halogen, halo(Ci.6)alkyl, hydroxy, hydroxy(Ci.6)alkyl, cyano, amino, amino(Ci-6)alkyl, Ci-3 alkylamino, and di(Ci-3)alkylamino. More preferably, R10, R11, R12, and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci-4 alkyl, Ci-3 alkoxy, halo, halo(Ci-3)alkyl, cyano, amino, amino (Ci-3)alkyl, Ci-3 alkylamino, and di(Ci-3)alkylamino. Advantageously, R10, R11, R12, and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, methyl, ethyl, methoxy, ethoxy, trifluoromethyl, cyano, amino, methylamino, and dimethylamino, and especially halogen. Preferably, R10 and R12 are both hydrogen. Preferably, either or both R11 and R13 are at the para-position of their respective phenyl rings.
[0136] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein Z is Z3 and R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy.
[0137] Useful compounds include those where R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, and cyano; naphthyl; quinolinyl; and pyridyl. [0138] Useful compounds include those where R14 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; preferably independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxy, cyano, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkyl, C1- 6 alkoxy, halo, halo(Ci_3)alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, Ci-3 alkylamino, and di(Ci_ 3)alkylamino. Advantageously, R14 is a phenyl group substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-propyl, tert-butyl, methoxy, ethoxy, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, methylamino, and dime thy lamino.
[0139] Useful compounds include those where R14 is phenyl substituted, preferably at the para-position, with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy any of which are unsubstituted or substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano, and preferably substituted with halogen.
[0140] Useful compounds also include those where R14 is unsubstituted naphthyl, quinolinyl or pyridyl.
[0141] Useful compounds include those where R14 is -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more, preferably one or two, substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy.
[0142] Preferably, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen when R14 is one of naphthyl; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with benzyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with phenoxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; or phenyl substituted with benzyloxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano.
[0143] Useful compounds also include those where Z is Z3, R8 and R9 together form =0, p is 0, D is -CH=CH- and R14 is n-propyl.
[0144] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R14 is alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy. Useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 together form =0, D is absent, and R14 is alkyl substituted with hydroxy, such as 1-hydroxybutyl, l-hydroxy-3-methylbutyl, and 1 -hydro xy-2- methylbutyl. [0145] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R15 is phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino. In this embodiment, R15 is preferably phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino. Useful compounds include those where R15 is phenyl substituted with Ci-6 alkyl, Ci-6 alkoxy, halogen, halo(Ci_ 3)alkyl, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino or di(Ci-3)alkylamino; and more preferably substituted with propyl, butyl, pentyl, propoxy, butoxy, pentoxy, fluoro, chloro, trifluoromethyl, amino, methylamino or dimethylamino. Useful compounds also include those where R15 is naphthyl substituted with amino, alkylamino or dialkylamino; preferably substituted with amino, Ci-3 alkylamino or di(Ci-3)alkylamino; and more preferably substituted with amino, methylamino or dimethylamino.
[0146] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of any of Formulae I-III, wherein R15 is alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo. Useful compounds include those where R15 is Ci-6 alkyl substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group of optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted naphthyl, and optionally substituted pyridyl.
[0147] Useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0 and D is absent or -CH=CH-. Useful compounds include those where R8 and R9 form =0 and D is -C(O)-. [0148] Useful compounds include those where D is -C(O)- or absent and R14 is -NR14aR14b.
[0149] Useful compounds include also those where D is -NH- or -N(alkyl)-.
[0150] Useful compounds of the present invention include those where Z is Z5 and R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as Ci-4 alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_4)alkyl, amino(Ci.4)alkyl, di(Ci-4)alkylamino(Ci-4)alkyl, diamino(Ci-4)alkyl, (Ci-4)alkoxy(Ci-4)alkyl, C3- 7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, benzyl, and pyridyl, such as 2-, 3-, or 4-pyridyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, phenyl, benzyl and pyridyl rings can be optionally substituted.
[0151] Useful compounds of the present invention include those where m is O or l.
[0152] Preferably, Z is Z2 and n is 0, 1 or 2.
[0153] Preferably, Z is Z3 and p is 0, 1 or 2.
[0154] Preferably, q is 2.
[0155] The invention also relates to compounds represented by Formula IV:
Figure imgf000047_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein R^R7, R32, R33, x, y, m, and q are as defined above. Preferred values for R1- R7, R32, R33, x, y, m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0156] The invention also relates to compounds represented by Formula V:
Figure imgf000048_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein R^R7, m and q are as defined above. Preferred values for R^R7, m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0157] In one aspect, preferred compounds falling within the scope of Formula V include those represented by Formula VI:
Figure imgf000049_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0158] R . 1 - πR3 and q are as described for Formula V;
[0159] R41 and R51 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; and
[0160] R18 and R19 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
[0161] Preferably, R41 and R51 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; and more preferably independently selected from hydrogen and alkyl. Useful compounds include those where R41 and R51 both are hydrogen, or R41 is hydrogen and R51 is Ci-3 alkyl, preferably methyl.
[0162] Preferably, R18 and R19 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci_6)alkyl, and C 1.6 alkoxy; more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-4 alkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci-3)alkyl, and Ci-4 alkoxy; and more preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, iso-propyl, tert-butyl, cyano, fiuoro, amino, methylamino, dimethylamino, nitro, trifluoromethyl, methoxy, iso-propoxy, and tert- butoxy. Useful compounds of Formula VI include those where R18 and R19 are both hydrogen, or R18 is hydrogen and R19 is methyl, tert-butyl, cyano, fiuoro, methylamino, dimethylamino, trifluoromethyl or methoxy, and especially cyano.
[0163] In another aspect, preferred compounds falling within the scope of Formula V include those represented by Formula VII:
Figure imgf000051_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs, and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0164] R^R3, m, and q are as defined above for Formula I;
[0165] R42 and R52 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or R 42 and
R , 52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or a 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl; and
[0166] R20 and R21 are independently H or CH3.
[0167] Preferred values for R . 1 - πR3 and q are those described for Formula I.
Preferably, R »42 and R » 52 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; more preferably selected from hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, and hydroxy(Ci.6)alkyl; more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, Ci-3 alkyl, and hydroxy(Ci_3)alkyl; and more preferably independently selected from hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl and hydroxyethyl; or R42 and R52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring selected from the group consisting of oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, 4- methylpiperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, and tetrahydropyridyl. Advantageously, R42 and R52 are independently hydrogen, methyl or hydroxyethyl; or R42 and R52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form 1 -pyrrolidinyl, 4-thiomorpholinyl, or 4-methylpiperazinyl.
[0168] Useful compounds of Formula VII include those where one of R 20 or R21 is CH3. Other useful compounds of Formula VII include those where R20 and R21 are both H when R42 and R52 together form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring. Also, useful compounds of Formula VII include those where R42 and R52 are both hydrogen, or R42 is hydrogen and R52 is alkyl. especially methyl. Preferably, m is 1 in compounds of Formula VII.
[0169] In one aspect, compounds falling within the scope of Formula IV include those represented by Formula VIII:
Figure imgf000053_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein R^R7, R32, R33, and q are as defined above. Preferred values for R^R7, R32,
R , 33 , and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0170] Useful compounds of Formula VIII include those where R ,33 is hydrogen. Useful compounds of Formula VIII also include those where R32 is hydroxy or alkyl or R32 and R33 together form a C3-6 cycloalkyl. Useful compounds of Formula VIII also include those where R32 and R4 together form a 5-membered heterocyclic ring.
[0171] In one aspect, compounds falling within the scope of Formula IV include those represented by Formula IX:
Figure imgf000054_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein R^R7, R32, R33, m and q are as defined above. Preferred values for R^R7, R32, R33, m, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0172] Useful compounds of Formula IX include those where R32 and R33 together form C5-6 cycloalkyl, R6 and R7 are hydrogen, m is 0, and R^R5 are as defined above. Another group of useful compounds are those where R33 is hydrogen, R32 is hydroxy and m is 0, and R^R7 are as defined above.
[0173] Another group of compounds useful in this aspect of the invention are compounds represented by the general Formula X:
Figure imgf000055_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0174] RJ-R3, R8-R13, A, B, q, and n are as defined above for Formulae I-III. Preferred values for R^R3, R8 -R13, A, B, n, and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0175] Further, compounds useful in the present invention are compounds of Formula XI:
Figure imgf000056_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0176] RJ-R3, R8, R9, R14, D, p, and q are as defined previously for Formula I. In Formula XI, preferred values for R1 -R3, R8, R9, R14, D, p and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0177] Additional compounds useful in the present invention are compounds represented by Formula XII:
Figure imgf000057_0001
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0178] R^R3, R15 and q are as defined previously for Formula I. In Formula XII, preferred values for R^R3, R15 and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0179] Additional compounds useful in the present invention are compounds represented by Formula XIII:
Figure imgf000057_0002
and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof, wherein:
[0180] RJ-R3, R30, R31, and q are as defined previously for Formula I. In Formula XIII, preferred values for R^R3, R30, R31 and q are those described above as preferred for Formula I.
[0181] Exemplary preferred compounds useful in the present invention include: N-[ 1 -(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-ethylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-[l-(3-amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [1 -(2 -methylcarbonylpropylamino-4-methyl- pentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methylpentanoyl]piperidin-
3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [l-(2-isopropylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl] -3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -methylamino-5 -methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl]-3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof.
[0182] Another group of useful compounds of the invention include: (2S) N-[I -(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; (2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)-piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-ethylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-
3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfbnamide; (2S) N-[l-(3-amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-methylcarbonylpropylamino-4-methyl- pentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methyl- pentanoyl]piperidin-3-yl} -3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-isopropylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)-piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-methylamino-5-methylhexanoyl)-piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; (2R) N-cyclopropyl-N- [1 -(3 -methylamino-5 -methylhexanoyl)-piperidin-3 - y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof.
[0183] Another group of useful compounds of the invention include: N-cyclopropyl-N-(l-{3-[bis-(4-fiuorophenyl)amino]propyl}-piperidin-3-yl)-
3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-isobutylaminopropionyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -isopropylaminopropionyl)-piperidin-3 -yl]-3 - trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-methoxyethylamino)-propionyl]-piperidin-3-yl} -
3 -trifiuoromethy 1-benzenesulfonamide ;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-hydroxyethylamino)-propionyl]-piperidin-3-yl} -3- trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(2-isobutylaminoacetyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzene-sulfonamide; 2- {3-[cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)-amino]-piperidin- 1 - yl} -N-isobutyl-acetamide;
N-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-{3-[cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzene- sulfonyl)amino]piperidin- 1 -yl} acetamide; 2-[3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamino)-pyrrolidin- 1 -yl]-N-(4- fluorophenyl)-acetamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-{l-[2-(4-methoxybenzylamino)acetyl]-piperidin-3-yl}-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-(l-{2-[(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)amino]acetyl}-piperidin-3-yl)- 3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates thereof.
[0184] Useful cycloalkyl groups are selected from saturated C3-I2 cycloalkyl. Typical cycloalkyl groups include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl, and cyclooctyl.
[0185] As used herein, the term "bicycloalkyl" refers to saturated alicyclic hydrocarbon systems consisting of two rings and having two or more atoms in common. Useful bicycloalkyl groups are selected from C4-I2 bicycloalkyl. Typical bicycloalkyl groups include bicyclobutyl, bicyclopentyl, bicyclohexyl, bicycloheptyl, and bicyclooctyl, especially bicyclo[3.1.0]hept- 3-yl.
[0186] Useful halo or halogen groups include fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
[0187] Useful alkyl groups are selected from straight-chained and branched Ci-io alkyl groups, more preferably straight chain C1-6 alkyl groups and branched chain C1-6 alkyl groups. Typical C1-10 alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, sec -butyl, tert-butyl, z'so-butyl, 3-pentyl, hexyl and octyl, among others. [0188] Useful alkenyl groups are selected from C2-6 alkenyl groups, preferably C2-4 alkenyl. Typical C2-4 alkenyl groups include ethenyl, propenyl, 2-propenyl, isopropenyl, butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, and sec- butenyl.
[0189] Useful alkynyl groups are selected from C2-6 alkynyl groups, preferably C2-4 alkynyl. Typical C2-4 alkynyl groups include ethynyl, propynyl, 2-propynyl, butynyl, 2-butynyl, and 3-butynyl groups.
[0190] Useful arylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted by any of the C6-I4 aryl groups mentioned below. Typical arylalkyl groups include benzyl, phenethyl, and naphthylmethyl.
[0191] Useful arylalkenyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C2-6 alkenyl groups substituted by any of the C6-I4 aryl groups mentioned below.
[0192] Useful arylalkynyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C2-6 alkynyl groups substituted by any of the C6-I4 aryl groups mentioned below.
[0193] As used herein, the term "benzylidenyl" refers to =CHPh.
[0194] As used herein, the term "benzyloxybenzyl" refers to a benzyl group substituted by a benzyloxy group at the phenyl ring of the benzyl group. Useful benzyloxybenzyl groups include 4-(benzyloxy)benzyl.
[0195] Useful cycloalkylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci.io alkyl groups substituted by any of the above-mentioned cycloalkyl groups.
[0196] Useful haloalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted by one or more fluorine, chlorine, bromine or iodine atoms (e.g., fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, pentafluoroethyl, 1,1-difluoroethyl and trichloromethyl groups).
[0197] Useful hydroxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted by hydroxy (e.g., hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, hydroxypropyl and hydroxybutyl groups, and especially hydroxymethyl, 1- hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3 -hydroxybutyl, and 2-hydroxy-l- methylpropyl).
[0198] Useful alkoxy groups include oxygen substituted by one of the C1-10 alkyl groups mentioned above.
[0199] Useful alkoxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted with any of the above-mentioned alkoxy groups.
[0200] Useful haloalkoxy groups include oxygen substituted by one of the Ci-io haloalkyl groups mentioned above (e.g., fluoromethoxy, difluoromethoxy, and trifiuoromethoxy).
[0201] Useful aryl groups are C6-14 aryl, especially C6-10 aryl. Typical C6-I4 aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, phenanthryl, anthracyl, indenyl, azulenyl, biphenyl, biphenylenyl, and fluorenyl groups, more preferably phenyl, naphthyl, and biphenyl groups.
[0202] The term "heteroaryl" as employed herein refers to groups having 5 to 14 ring atoms, with 6, 10 or 14 π electrons shared in a cyclic array, and containing carbon atoms and 1, 2, or 3 oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur heteroatoms. Examples of heteroaryl groups include thienyl, benzo[b]thienyl, naphtho[2,3-b]thienyl, thianthrenyl, furyl, benzofuryl, pyranyl, isobenzofuranyl, benzooxazonyl, chromenyl, xanthenyl, 2H- pyrrolyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyridazinyl, isoindolyl, 3H-indolyl, indolyl, indazolyl, purinyl, isoquinolyl, quinolyl, phthalazinyl, naphthyridinyl, cinnolinyl, quinazolinyl, pteridinyl, 4aH-carbazolyl, carbazolyl, β-carbolinyl, phenanthridinyl, acridinyl, pyrimidinyl, phenanthrolinyl, phenazinyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, phenothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, furazanyl, and phenoxazinyl. Preferred heteroaryl groups include thienyl, furyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, and isoxazolyl.
[0203] Useful heteroarylalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1- io alkyl groups substituted by any of the heteroaryl groups mentioned below. Useful values include, for example, 2-pyridylmethyl, 3-pyridylmethyl, 4- pyridylmethyl.
[0204] The terms "heterocyclic" and "heterocyclo" are used herein to mean saturated or wholly or partially unsaturated 3-7 membered monocyclic, or 7- 10 membered bicyclic ring system, which consist of carbon atoms and from one to four heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of O, N, and S, wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms can be optionally oxidized, the nitrogen can be optionally quaternized, and including any bicyclic group in which any of the above-defined heterocyclic rings is fused to a benzene ring, and wherein the heterocyclic ring can be substituted on a carbon atom or on a nitrogen atom if the resulting compound is stable. Examples include, but are not limited to, pyrrolidine, piperidine, piperazine, morpholine, imidazoline, pyrazolidine, benzodiazepines, and the like.
[0205] Useful heterocycloalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted by any of the above-mentioned heterocyclic groups.
[0206] As used herein, the term "amino" or "amino group" refers to -NH2.
[0207] Useful aminoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned Ci-I0 alkyl groups substituted with an amino group. [0208] Useful diaminoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted with two amino groups.
[0209] Useful alkylamino and dialkylamino groups are — NHR22 and — NR22R23, respectively, wherein R22 and R23 are each independently selected from a Ci-I0 alkyl group.
[0210] Useful alkylaminoalkyl and dialkylaminoalkyl groups are any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted by any of the above- mentioned alkylamino and dialkylamino groups, respectively.
[0211] Useful alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl groups include any of the above- mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted by an alkyl-SC>2-NH- group.
[0212] Useful aminocarbonylalkyl groups include any of the above- mentioned Ci-io alkyl groups substituted with an aminocarbonyl group, i.e., - C(O)NH2.
[0213] Useful alkylcarbonyl groups include a carbonyl group, i.e., -C(O)-, substituted by any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups.
[0214] Useful haloalkylcarbonyl groups include a carbonyl group substituted by any of the above-mentioned haloalkyl groups.
[0215] Useful alkylcarbonylamino groups include any of the above- mentioned alkylcarbonyl groups attached to an amino nitrogen, such as methylcarbony lamino .
[0216] Useful mercaptoalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1- io alkyl groups substituted by a -SH group. [0217] As used herein, the term "carboxy" refers to -COOH.
[0218] Useful carboxyalkyl groups include any of the above-mentioned C1-10 alkyl groups substituted by -COOH.
[0219] As used herein, the term "ureido" refers to -NH-C(O)-NH2.
[0220] As used herein, the term "azido" refers to -N3.
[0221] As used herein, the term "optionally substituted" refers to a group that can be unsubstituted or substituted.
[0222] Optional substituents on optionally substituted groups, when not otherwise indicated, include one or more groups, preferably 1, 2, or 3 groups, independently selected from the group consisting of halo, halo(Ci.6)alkyl, aryl, heterocycle, cycloalkyl, C1-6 alkyl, C2-6 alkenyl, C2-6 alkynyl, aryl(Ci_ 6)alkyl, aryl(C2-6)alkenyl, aryl(C2-6)alkynyl, cycloalkyl(Ci-6)alkyl, heterocyclo(Ci_6)alkyl, hydroxy(Ci_6)alkyl, amino(Ci-6)alkyl, carboxy(Ci_ 6)alkyl, alkoxy(Ci.6)alkyl, nitro, amino, ureido, cyano, alkylcarbonylamino, hydroxy, thiol, alkylcarbonyloxy, azido, alkoxy, carboxy, aminocarbonyl, and C i-6 alkylthiol groups mentioned above. Preferred optional substituents include halo, halo(Ci-6)alkyl, hydroxy(Ci-6)alkyl, amino(Ci-6)alkyl, hydroxy, nitro, C1-6 alkyl, alkoxy, and amino.
[0223] The invention disclosed herein is also intended to encompass prodrugs of any of the disclosed compounds. As used herein, prodrugs are considered to be any covalently bonded carriers that release the active parent drug in vivo. Non-limiting examples of prodrugs include esters or amides of compounds of any of Formulae I-XIII having hydroxyalkyl or aminoalkyl as a substituent, and these may be prepared by reacting such compounds with anhydrides such as succinic anhydride. [0224] The invention disclosed herein is also intended to encompass any of the disclosed compounds being isotopically-labelled by having one or more atoms replaced by an atom having a different atomic mass or mass number. Examples of isotopes that can be incorporated into the disclosed compounds include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, fluorine and chlorine, such as 2H, 3H, 11C, 13C, 14C, 15N, 18O, 170, 31P, 32P, 35S, 18F, and 36Cl, respectively, and preferably 3H, 11C, and 14C. Isotopically- labeled compounds of the present invention can be prepared by methods known in the art.
[0225] The present invention is also directed specifically to 3H, 11C, or 14C radiolabeled compounds of any of Formulae I-XIII, as well as their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, prodrugs and solvates, and the use of any such compounds as radioligands for their binding site on the calcium channel. For example, one use of the labeled compounds of the present invention is the characterization of specific receptor binding. Another use of a labeled compound of the present invention is an alternative to animal testing for the evaluation of structure-activity relationships. For example, the receptor assay may be performed at a fixed concentration of a labeled compound of the invention and at increasing concentrations of a test compound in a competition assay. For example, a tritiated compound of any of Formulae I- XIII can be prepared by introducing tritium into the particular compound, for example, by catalytic dehalogenation with tritium. This method may include reacting a suitably halogen-substituted precursor of the compound with tritium gas in the presence of a suitable catalyst, for example, Pd/C, in the presence or absence of a base. Other suitable methods for preparing tritiated compounds can be found in Filer, Isotopes in the Physical and Biomedical Sciences, Vol. 1, Labeled Compounds (Part A), Chapter 6 (1987). Relabeled compounds can be prepared by employing starting materials having a 14C carbon. l ^-labeled compounds can be prepared by employing starting materials having a 11C carbon. [0226] Some of the compounds disclosed herein may contain one or more asymmetric centers and may thus give rise to enantiomers, diastereomers, and other stereoisomeric forms. The present invention is meant to encompass the uses of all such possible forms, as well as their racemic and resolved forms and mixtures thereof. The individual enantiomers may be separated according to methods known to those of ordinary skill in the art in view of the present disclosure. When the compounds described herein contain olefinic double bonds or other centers of geometric asymmetry, and unless specified otherwise, it is intended that they include both E and Z geometric isomers. All tautomers are intended to be encompassed by the present invention as well.
[0227] As used herein, the term "stereoisomers" is a general term for all isomers of individual molecules that differ only in the orientation of their atoms in space. It includes enantiomers and isomers of compounds with more than one chiral center that are not mirror images of one another (diastereomers).
[0228] The term "chiral center" refers to a carbon atom to which four different groups are attached.
[0229] The terms "enantiomer" and "enantiomeric" refer to a molecule that cannot be superimposed on its mirror image and hence is optically active wherein the enantiomer rotates the plane of polarized light in one direction and its mirror image compound rotates the plane of polarized light in the opposite direction.
[0230] The term "racemic" refers to a mixture of equal parts of enantiomers and which mixture is optically inactive.
[0231] The term "resolution" refers to the separation or concentration or depletion of one of the two enantiomeric forms of a molecule. [0232] The terms "a" and "an" refer to one or more.
[0233] The invention disclosed herein also encompasses the use of salts of the disclosed compounds, including all non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof of the disclosed compounds. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable addition salts include inorganic and organic acid addition salts and basic salts. The pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, metal salts such as sodium salt, potassium salt, cesium salt and the like; alkaline earth metals such as calcium salt, magnesium salt and the like; organic amine salts such as triethylamine salt, pyridine salt, picoline salt, ethanolamine salt, triethanolamine salt, dicyclohexylamine salt, N,N'-dibenzylethylenediamine salt and the like; inorganic acid salts such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, phosphate, sulphate and the like; organic acid salts such as citrate, lactate, tartrate, maleate, fumarate, mandelate, acetate, dichloroacetate, trifluoroacetate, oxalate, formate and the like; sulfonates such as methanesulfonate, benzenesulfonate, p-toluenesulfonate and the like; and amino acid salts such as arginate, asparginate, glutamate and he like.
[0234] Acid addition salts can be formed by mixing a solution of the particular compound of the present invention with a solution of a pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic acid such as hydrochloric acid, fumaric acid, maleic acid, succinic acid, acetic acid, citric acid, tartaric acid, carbonic acid, phosphoric acid, oxalic acid, dichloroacetic acid, or the like. Basic salts can be formed by mixing a solution of the compound of the present invention with a solution of a pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic base such as sodium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, choline hydroxide, sodium carbonate and the like.
[0235] The invention disclosed herein is also meant to encompass solvates of any of the disclosed compounds. One type of solvate is a hydrate. Solvates typically do not significantly alter the physiological activity or toxicity of the compounds, and as such may function as pharmacological equivalents.
[0236] Since compounds of Formulae I-XIII are blockers of calcium (Ca2+) channels, a number of diseases and conditions mediated by calcium ion influx can be treated by employing these compounds. The present invention is thus directed generally to a method for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels, and particularly the selective blockade of N-type calcium channels, in an animal suffering from, or at risk of suffering from, said disorder, said method comprising administering to the animal an effective amount of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
[0237] The present invention is further directed to a method of modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in an animal in need thereof, said method comprising administering to the animal at least one compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
[0238] More specifically, the present invention provides a method of treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, the neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain (e.g., chronic pain, neuropathic pain, inflammatory pain, or acute pain), migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (e.g., Alzheimer's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), or Parkinson's disease), depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia. In one embodiment, the invention provides a method of treating pain. In another embodiment, the type of pain treated is chronic pain. In another embodiment, the type of pain treated is neuropathic pain. In another embodiment, the type of pain treated is inflammatory pain. In another embodiment, the type of pain treated is acute pain. In each instance, such method of treatment, prevention, or amelioration requires administering to an animal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration an amount of a compound of the present invention that is therapeutically effective in achieving said treatment, prevention or amelioration. In one embodiment, the amount of such compound is the amount that is effective as to block calcium channels in vivo.
[0239] Chronic pain includes, but is not limited to, inflammatory pain, postoperative pain, cancer pain, osteoarthritis pain associated with metastatic cancer, trigeminal neuralgia, acute herpetic and postherpetic neuralgia, diabetic neuropathy, causalgia, brachial plexus avulsion, occipital neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, fibromyalgia, gout, phantom limb pain, burn pain, and other forms of neuralgia, neuropathic, and idiopathic pain syndromes.
[0240] Chronic somatic pain generally results from inflammatory responses to tissue injury such as nerve entrapment, surgical procedures, cancer or arthritis (Brower, Nature Biotechnology 2000; 18: 387-391).
[0241] The inflammatory process is a complex series of biochemical and cellular events activated in response to tissue injury or the presence of foreign substances (Levine, Inflammatory Pain, In: Textbook of Pain, Wall and Melzack eds., 3rd ed., 1994). Inflammation often occurs at the site of injured tissue, or foreign material, and contributes to the process of tissue repair and healing. The cardinal signs of inflammation include erythema (redness), heat, edema (swelling), pain and loss of function (ibid.). The majority of patients with inflammatory pain do not experience pain continually, but rather experience enhanced pain when the inflamed site is moved or touched. Inflammatory pain includes, but is not limited to, that associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis.
[0242] Chronic neuropathic pain is a heterogenous disease state with an unclear etiology. In chronic neuropathic pain, the pain can be mediated by multiple mechanisms. This type of pain generally arises from injury to the peripheral or central nervous tissue. The syndromes include pain associated with spinal cord injury, multiple sclerosis, post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, phantom pain, causalgia, and reflex sympathetic dystrophy and lower back pain. Chronic pain is different from acute pain in that patients suffer the abnormal pain sensations that can be described as spontaneous pain, continuous superficial burning and/or deep aching pain. The pain can be evoked by heat-, cold-, and mechano-hyperalgesia or by heat-, cold-, or mechano-allodynia.
[0243] Neuropathic pain can be caused by injury or infection of peripheral sensory nerves. It includes, but is not limited to, pain from peripheral nerve trauma, herpes virus infection, diabetes mellitus, causalgia, plexus avulsion, neuroma, limb amputation, and vasculitis. Neuropathic pain is also caused by nerve damage from chronic alcoholism, human immunodeficiency virus infection, hypothyroidism, uremia, or vitamin deficiences. Stroke (spinal or brain) and spinal cord injury can also induce neuropathic pain. Cancer- related neuropathic pain results from tumor growth compression of adjacent nerves, brain, or spinal cord. In addition, cancer treatments, including chemotherapy and radiation therapy, can also cause nerve injury.
Neuropathic pain includes but is not limited to pain caused by nerve injury such as, for example, the pain from which diabetics suffer.
[0244] The present invention is also directed to the use of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels (e.g., any of the disorders listed above) in an animal suffering from said disorder. In one embodiment, the disorder is responsive to the selective blockade of N-type calcium channels. [0245] The present invention is also directed to the use of a compound represented by any of defined Formulae I-XIII, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for modulating calcium channels, especially N-type calcium channels, in an animal in need thereof.
Synthesis of Compounds
[0246] The compounds of the present invention can be prepared using methods known to those skilled in the art in view of this disclosure. For example, compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 can be prepared as shown in Schemes 1-5.
Scheme 1
O NHR3 R24°2S^NR3
+ R3NH2 DCEZNaB(OAc)3H A| + R24 1 DMC/TEA
,NBoc k .NBoc " 2 ' 2 HCI/1 ,4 di-oxane L H HCI
Figure imgf000072_0001
wherein R24 is
Figure imgf000072_0002
[0247] In Scheme 1, R1, R2, and R3 are as defined above for Formula I. R6 and R7 are as defined above, or R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cyclolalkyl group.
[0248] Similarly, compounds of Formula I, where Z is Z1, y is 1, and x is 0 or 1 can be prepared according to Scheme 1 by choosing appropriate acids as starting materials. [0249] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 and m is 1 can be prepared as follows:
Scheme 2
Figure imgf000073_0001
where R3 and R7 are as defined for Formula I and R24 is as described above in Scheme 1.
[0250] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 and m is 1 can also be prepared using the Michael addition reaction of amines to α,β-unsaturated amides as shown in Scheme 3:
Scheme 3
Figure imgf000073_0002
where R3-R5, R7 and R24 are as defined above.
[0251] Further compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 can be prepared as follows: Scheme 4
Figure imgf000074_0001
where R3, R4, R7 and R24 are as defined above and R and R" are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo.
[0252] A further method for preparing compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 can be follows:
Scheme 5
Figure imgf000074_0002
where R3-R5, R7, and R24 are as defined above.
[0253] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z2, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, A is -C(O)- and B is N can be prepared as shown in Scheme 6: Scheme 6
R25R26NH + XCH2(CH2)n.COCI TEA/Tθluenθ,
Figure imgf000075_0001
Figure imgf000075_0002
wherein R25 is
Figure imgf000075_0003
[0254] In Scheme 6, R3 is as defined for Formula I and R24 is as defined above in Scheme 1.
[0255] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z3 and R14 is -NR14aR14b can be prepared using the method described in Scheme 6 where R25 and R26 are as defined above for R14a and R14b, respectively.
[0256] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z2, R8 and R9 together form =0, A is CH2 or absent and B is N can be prepared as shown in Scheme 7:
Scheme 7
Figure imgf000075_0004
wherein R3 and R24-R26 are as defined in Scheme 6.
[0257] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 and R5 is R16-C(O)- or R16-SC>2- can be prepared as shown in Scheme 8: Scheme 8
Figure imgf000076_0001
where R3, R4, R7, R16 and R24 are as defined above.
[0258] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 and R5 is hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted with an optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl can be prepared as shown in Scheme 9:
Scheme 9
Figure imgf000076_0002
where R3, R4, R7 and R24 are as defined above and R27 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted aryl, and optionally substituted benzyl. The carbons to which R7 and R27 are attached can be chiral centers and, thus, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
[0259] Another method for preparing compounds of Formula I where Z is Z1 and R5 is hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted with an optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl can be prepared as shown in Scheme 10: Scheme 10
Figure imgf000077_0001
where R3, R4, R7, and R24 are as defined above and R28 and R29 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, optionally substituted aryl, and optionally substituted benzyl. The carbon atoms to which R7, R28 and R29 are attached can be chiral centers and, thus, the configuration at those carbon atoms can be (R) or (S).
[0260] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z2 and R8 and R9 together form =0 can be prepared as shown in Scheme 11 :
Scheme 11
Figure imgf000077_0002
where R*-R3 and R10-R13 are as defined above for Formula I.
[0261] Accordingly, the amine and carboxylic acid are added in dry THF under nitrogen atmosphere. HOBT, EDCI, and triethylamine are added to the mixture, and the mixture is stirred at room temperature overnight. The resulting mixture is partitioned between ethyl acetate and 1.0 M sodium chloride. The organic layer is separated, dried and concentrated to give a crude product, which can be purified by crystallization by hexane/ether.
[0262] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z2 and R8 and R9 both are hydrogen can be prepared as shown in Scheme 12:
Scheme 12
Figure imgf000078_0001
where R*-R3 and R10-R13 are as described above.
[0263] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z3 and R8 and R9 are both hydrogen can be synthesized as shown in Scheme 13:
Scheme 13
Figure imgf000078_0002
where R , 1 - πR3 are as defined for Formula I, X is Cl or Br, and R' can be, for example, alkenyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted naphthyl, quinolinyl, pyridyl, or -(CH2)p-D-NR14aR14b, wherein p, D, R14a and R14b are as defined above. [0264] For example, the amine, i.e., the piperidinyl compound, is dissolved in DMF and triethylamine added, followed by a halide R'CH^X, wherein R' is an optionally substituted phenyl. The reaction mixture is stirred for 12 hours at 80 0C and the solvent is evaporated. The residue can be purified by flash chromatography to give the desired product. When the appropriate benzyl halides are not available, corresponding aldehydes, R'C(O)H, can be used as follows: sodium triacetoxyborohydride (1.4 eq.) is added to a solution of an amine and an aldehyde in dichloroethane. The reaction mixture is stirred at room temperature for 12 hours. After this period, the solution is decanted and purified by flash chromatography to give the desired product.
[0265] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z3 and R8 and R9 together form =0 can be synthesized using a method similar to that described in Scheme 11.
[0266] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z4 can be prepared a shown in Scheme 14:
Scheme 14
Figure imgf000079_0001
where R*-R3 are as defined for Formula I. For example, 0.5 mmol of sulfonamide and approximately 0.5 mmol of the appropriate sulfonyl chloride are dissolved in 5 mL of DCM and combined with 1.5 eq. DIEA (0.134 mL) that is added by syringe. The mixture is stirred overnight at room temperature, and then concentrated under vacuum. The resulting product can be purified by using a column of silica gel with a gradient of 0 % to 20 % EtOAc in hexanes and the pure material is concentrated from the eluant.
[0267] Compounds of Formula I where Z is Z5 can be prepared as shown in Scheme 15:
Scheme 15
Figure imgf000080_0001
where R' and R" are as defined above for R30 and R31.
[0268] Compounds of Formulae I-XIII where q is 0, 1 or 3 can be prepared using methods analogous to those described above for corresponding compounds where q is 2.
Testing of Compounds
[0269] Compounds of the present invention were assessed by calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays for calcium channel blocker activity. One aspect of the present invention is based on the use of the compounds herein described as N-type calcium channel blockers. In one aspect of the present invention, it has been found that certain compounds herein described show selectivity as N-type calcium channel blockers. Based upon this property, these compounds are considered useful in treating, preventing, or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder (such as, e.g., Alzheimer's disease, ALS, or Parkinson's disease), a psychosis, depression, anxiety, hypertension, or cardiac arrhythmia. The compounds of the present invention are also expected to be effective in treating, preventing or ameliorating pain, such as acute pain, chronic pain, which includes but is not limited to neuropathic pain and inflammatory pain, or surgical pain.
[0270] More specifically, the present invention is directed to compounds of Formulae I-XIII that are blockers of calcium channels. According to the present invention, those compounds having preferred N-type calcium channel blocking properties exhibit an IC50 of about 100 μM or less in the calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays described herein. Preferably, the compounds of the present invention exhibit an IC50 of 10 μM or less. Most preferably, the compounds of the present invention exhibit an IC50 of about 1.0 μM or less. Compounds of the present invention can be tested for their N-type and L-type Ca + channel blocking activity by the following calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays.
[0271] In one embodiment, compounds useful in the present invention are those represented by any one of Formulae I-XIII that exhibit selectivity for N-type calcium channels over L-type calcium channels in the calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assays described herein. The phrase "selectivity for N-type calcium channels over L-type calcium channels" is used herein to mean that the ratio of an IC50 for L-type channel blocking activity for a compound of the present invention over an IC50 for N-type channel blocking activity for the same compound is more than 1, i.e., LTCC IC50/ NTCC IC50 > 1. Preferably, compounds of the present invention exhibit an LTCC IC50 / NTCC IC50 ratio of about 2 or more, about 10 or more, about 20 or more, about 30 or more, about 50 or more, or about 100 or more. Calcium Mobilization and Electrophysiological Assay Protocols:
[0272] Cell maintenance and differentiation. Unless noted otherwise, cell culture reagents were purchased from Mediatech of Herndon, MD. IMR32 cells (American Type Culture Collection, ATCC, Manassas, VA) were routinely cultured in growth medium consisting of minimum essential medium containing 10% fetal bovine serum (FBS, Hyclone, Logan, UT), 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 μg/mL streptomycin, 2 mM L-glutamine, 1 mM sodium pyruvate, and Ix MEM non-essential amino acids. 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium:
Growth medium plus 1 mM dibutyryl cyclic AMP (Sigma, St. Louis, MO), and 2.5 μM bromodeoxyuridine (Sigma). Cells were differentiated for 8 days by replacing differentiation medium every 2-3 days.
[0273] A7r5 (ATCC) cells were maintained and routinely cultured in A7r5 growth medium consisting of Dulbecco's Modified Eagles Medium containing 10 % FBS, 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 μg/mL streptomycin, 4 mM L-glutamine, and 0.15% sodium bicarbonate. 80-90 % confluent flasks of cells were differentiated using the following differentiation medium: A7r5 Growth Medium plus 1 mM dibutyryl cyclic AMP (Sigma). Cells were differentiated for 8 days by replacing differentiation medium every 2-3 days.
[0274] Recombinant human embryonal kidney cells (HEK293, ATCC) stably transfected with either N-type calcium channel (NTCC) subunits (αlb, α2δ, and β3) or L-type calcium channel (LTCC) subunits (αlc, α2δ, and βl) were routinely cultured in growth medium consisting of Dulbecco's Modified Eagles Medium containing 10 % FBS, 100 U/mL penicillin, 100 μg/mL streptomycin, 4 mM L-glutamine, 500 μg/mL geneticin (G418), 20 μg/mL Blasticidin S (InVivogen, San Diego, CA) and 500 μg/mL zeocin (InVivogen). [0275] FLIPR Calcium Mobilization Assay for N-type Calcium Channel. One day prior to performing this assay, differentiated IMR32 cells were treated with Ix CellStripper, and seeded on poly-D-lysine-coated 96-well clear-bottom black plates (Becton Dickinson, Franklin Lakes, NJ) at 200,000 cells/well. On the day of the assay, the cell plates were washed with IMR32 buffer (127 mM NaCl, 1 mM KCl, 2 mM MgCl2, 700 μM NaH2PO4, 5 mM CaCl2, 5 mM NaHCO3, 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4), then pre- stimulated with KCl and loaded as follows: 0.05 mL of IMR32 buffer, 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in IMR32 buffer containing 20 μM nitrendipine (Sigma), and 0.1 mL KCl dissolved in IMR32 buffer, plus Fluo- 4 were added (3 μM final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR). Final test compound concentrations ranged from about 846 pM to about 17 μM, final nitrendipine concentration was 5 μM, and final KCl concentration was 90 mM. After 1 hour, the cells were washed twice with 0.05 mL of each compound tested in nitrendipine-containing IMR32 buffer (no KCl or Fluo- 4), and then replaced with 0.1 mL of each compound tested in nitrendipine- containing IMR32 buffer. Plates were then transferred to a Fluorimetric Imaging Plate Reader (FLIPR96, Molecular Devices, Inc., Sunnyvale, CA) for assay. The FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds (i.e., 5 minutes and 15 seconds), then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in
IMR32 buffer and measured fluorescence for another 45 seconds. Final test compound concentrations on the cells after FLIPR read ranged from about 846 pM to about 17 μM, final nitrendipine concentration was 5 μM, and final KCl concentration was 90 mM. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism (version 3.02, Graph Pad, San Diego, CA), or an in-house non-linear regression analysis software.
[0276] FLIPR Calcium Mobilization Assay for L-type Calcium Channel. One day prior to performing this assay, HEK293 cells stably expressing recombinant rat L-type calcium channel (LTCC) subunits (αlc, α2δ, and βl) were trypsinized, then seeded on poly-D-lysine-coated 96-well clear-bottom black plates (Becton Dickinson, Franklin Lakes, NJ) at 75,000 cells/well. On the day of the assay, the plates were washed with LTCC wash buffer (127 mM NaCl, 2 mM MgCl2, 700 μM NaH2PO4, 5 mM CaCl2, 5 mM NaHCO3, 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4), then loaded with 0.1 mL of LTCC wash buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 μM final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR). After 1 hour, the cells were washed with 0.1 mL LTCC wash buffer and resuspended in 0.05 mL LTCC assay buffer (same composition as LTCC wash buffer). Plates were then transferred to a FLIPR96 for assay. The FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 15 seconds, then added 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in LTCC assay buffer at final concentrations ranging from about 846 pM to about 17 μM. Fluo-4 fluorescence was then measured for 5 minutes. 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in LTCC assay buffer was then added to the cells to produce a final concentration of 90 mM KCl, and fluorescence was measured for another 45 seconds. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or an in-house regression analysis software.
[0277] Alternative FLIPR Calcium Mobilization Assay for L-type Calcium Channel. Alternatively, the following cell line and procedure may be used for the FLIPR calcium mobilization assay for L-type calcium channel. One day prior to performing this assay, differentiated A7r5 cells are trypsinized, then seeded on tissue culture treated 96-well clear-bottom black plates (Becton Dickinson, Franklin Lakes, NJ) at a dilution of 1 : 1 from a confluent T 150 cm2 flask. On the day of the assay, the plates are washed with A7r5 wash buffer (127 mM NaCl, 2 mM MgCl2, 700 μM NaH2PO4, 5 mM CaCl2, 5 mM NaHCO3, 8 mM HEPES, 10 mM glucose, pH 7.4), then loaded with 0.1 mL of A7r5 wash buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 μM final concentration, Molecular Probes, Eugene, OR). After 1 hour, the cells are washed with 0.1 mL A7r5 wash buffer and resuspended in 0.05 mL A7r5 assay buffer that is composed of A7r5 wash buffer plus 50 μM valinomycin (Sigma). Plates are then transferred to a FLIPR96 for assay. The FLIPR measures basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 15 seconds, then adds 0.05 mL of each compound tested diluted in A7r5 assay buffer at final concentrations ranging from about 846 pM to about 17 μM. Fluo-4 fluorescence is then measured for 5 minutes. 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in A7r5 assay buffer is then added to the cells to produce a final concentration of 90 mM KCl, and fluorescence was measured for another 45 seconds. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or an in-house regression analysis software.
[0278] Cloning of N- and L-type calcium channel subunit open reading frame cDNAs. Five cDNAs encoding subunits of the rat N- or L-type calcium channels were cloned by PCR amplification in order to reconstitute functional channels in a heterologous system. These were the alpha Ib (αlb), betal (βl), beta3 (β3), alpha2delta (α2δ), and alphalc (αlc) subunit cDNAs. The alphalb subunit cDNA has been described by Dubel et al. in Proc. Natl. Acad Sci. U.S.A 89: 5058-5062 (1992). The betal subunit cDNA has been described by Pragnell et al. in FEBS Lett. 291: 253-258 (1991). The beta3 subunit cDNA has been described by Castellano et al. in J Biol. Chem. 268: 12359-12366 (1993). The alpha2delta subunit cDNA has been described by Kim et al. in Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A. 89: 3251-3255 (1992). The alphalc subunit cDNA has been described by Koch et al. in J Biol. Chem. 265: 17786-17791 (1990).
[0279] The 7.0 kb cDNA containing the entire αlb open reading frame (ORF) was PCR amplified as two overlapping cDNA fragments, i.e., a 2.7 kb 5' fragment and a 4.4 kb 3' fragment. The 5' fragment was amplified from rat brain cDNA using primers 1 (SEQ ID NO: 1 , TABLE 1) and 2 (SEQ ID NO:2, TABLE 1), and the 3' fragment was amplified from rat spinal cord cDNA using primers 3 (SEQ ID NO:3, TABLE 1) and 4 (SEQ ID NO:4, TABLE 1). The two fragments were joined by ligation at a common restriction site to create the entire 7.0 kb cDNA. This ORF encodes the protein isoform generated by alternative splicing termed "+A ΔSFMG ΔET" according to the nomenclature of Lin et al. (Neuron 18: 153-166 (1997)). The entire cDNA was sequenced with redundant coverage on both strands. The cDNA was then inserted into the mammalian expression vector pcDNA6.2DEST (Invitrogen, Carlsbad CA) by homologous recombination using the Gateway system (Invitrogen).
[0280] The 1.8 kb cDNA encoding the βl subunit, the 1.45 cDNA encoding the beta3 subunit, and the 3.3 kb cDNA encoding the alpha2delta subunit were cloned by PCR amplification from rat spinal cord cDNA (βl) or brain cDNA (β3, α2δ). Primers 5 (SEQ ID NO:5, TABLE 1) and 6 (SEQ ID NO:6, TABLE 1) were used for the βl cDNA amplification; primers 7 (SEQ ID NO:7, TABLE 1) and 8 (SEQ ID NO:8, TABLE 1) were used for the β3 cDNA amplification; and primers 9 (SEQ ID NO:9, TABLE 1) and 10 (SEQ ID NO: 10, TABLE 1) were used for the α2δ cDNA amplification. PCR products were subcloned and fully sequenced on both strands. Clones matching the reference sequence (βl: NMJH7346; β3: NMJH2828; α2δ: M86621) and the gene's GenBank rat genomic DNA sequences were recombined into the mammalian expression vector pcDNA3.2DEST (βl, β3) or pcDNA3.1-Zeo (α2δ), which had been modified to a vector compatible with the Gateway recombination system using the Gateway vector adaptor kit (Invitrogen). Proper recombination was confirmed by sequencing of recombinogenic regions. For β3 expression vector, proper protein expression was confirmed by Western blot analysis of lysates of transfected HEK293 cells using a rabbit polyclonal antiserum directed against the rat β3 subunit (USA Biological).
[0281] The 6.5 kb cDNA encoding the L-type calcium channel αlc subunit was cloned by PCR amplification from rat heart cDNA using primers 11 (SEQ ID NO: 11, TABLE 1) and 12 (SEQ ID NO: 12, TABLE 1). The PCR fragment was subcloned and fully sequenced on both strands to confirm its identity. A clone matching consensus reference sequence M59786 and rat genomic DNA sequences was recombined into the mammalian expression vector pcDNA6.2DEST. Sequences around the recombinogenic region were sequenced to confirm accurate recombination into the expression vector.
TABLE 1
Figure imgf000087_0001
[0282] N-type Recombinant Cell Line Development. N-type calcium channel expressing HEK-293 cells were created in two stages. Stage 1 was created as follows. The rat αlb, and β3 cDNA expression constructs (2.5 μg each) were co-transfected into human embryonic kidney (HEK-293) cells by
Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 μg/mL blasticidin and 500 μg/mL geneticin, and incubated for 3 weeks at 37 0C, 5 % CO2, 95 % humidity. Plates containing ≤ 1 clone per well were cultured until wells positive for single clones were confluent. Individual clones were then arrayed into columns of a destination 96-well plate, and partly split into 6-well plates for culture maintenance. Array plates were washed once with IMR32 buffer and cells loaded for 1 hour with 0.1 mL of IMR32 buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 μM final concentration, Molecular Probes). Then they were washed twice with 0.1 mL of IMR32 buffer, and replaced with 0.1 mL IMR32 buffer. Plates were then transferred to a FLIPR96 for assay. The FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds, then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in IMR32 buffer and measured fluorescence for another 45 seconds. Final KCl concentration was 90 mM. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or Activity Base (version 5.1, IDBS, Parsippany, NJ) software. The clone with the greatest signal-to-noise ratio, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) was expanded, characterized and used for stage 2 cell line development.
[0283] Stage 2 of N-type cell line development was carried out as follows. The rat α2δ cDNA expression construct (5 μg each) was transfected into the stage 1 N-type clonal cell line by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 μg/mL blasticidin, 500 μg/mL geneticin, and 250 μg/mL zeocin and incubated for 3 weeks at 37°C, 5% CO2, 95% humidity. Plates containing ≤ 1 clone per well were cultured and handled according to the same steps and procedures described above for the stage 1 cell line. The three clones with the greatest signal-to-noise, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) were expanded, characterized and tested in electrophysiology for the best current size, N-type pharmacology, N-type characteristic current-voltage relationship and kinetics as described below.
[0284] L-type Recombinant Cell Line Development. L-type calcium channel expressing HEK-293 cells were created in two stages. Stage 1 was created as follows. The rat αlc, and βl cDNA expression constructs (2.5 μg each) were co-transfected into human embryonic kidney (HEK-293) cells by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 μg/mL blasticidin and 500 μg/mL geneticin, and incubated for 3 weeks at 37 0C, 5 % CO2, 95 % humidity. Plates containing ≤ 1 clone per well were cultured until wells positive for single clones were confluent. Individual clones were then arrayed into columns of a destination 96-well plate, and partly split into 6-well plates for culture maintenance. Array plates were washed once with LTCC wash (or assay) buffer and cells loaded for 1 hour with 0.1 mL of LTCC buffer containing Fluo-4 (3 μM final concentration, Molecular Probes). Then they were washed twice with 0.1 mL of LTCC buffer, and replaced with 0.1 mL LTCC buffer. Plates were then transferred to a FLIPR96 for assay. The FLIPR measured basal Fluo-4 fluorescence for 315 seconds, then added 0.1 mL KCl agonist dissolved in LTCC buffer and measured fluorescence for another 45 seconds. Final KCl concentration was 90 mM. Data were collected over the entire time course and analyzed using Excel, Graph Pad Prism, or Activity Base software. The clone with the greatest signal-to-noise ratio, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) was expanded, characterized and used for stage 2 cell line development.
[0285] Stage 2 of L-type cell line development was carried out as follows. The rat α2δ cDNA expression construct (5 μg each) was transfected into the stage 1 L-type clonal cell line by Lipofectamine Plus reagent (Invitrogen), as per manufacturer's instructions. 24 hours later, cells were split in limiting dilution into multiple 96-well plates in selection media containing 20 μg/mL blasticidin, 500 μg/mL geneticin, and 250 μg/mL zeocin and incubated for 3 weeks at 37°C, 5% CO2, 95% humidity. Plates containing ≤ 1 clone per well were cultured and handled according to the same steps and procedures described above for the stage 1 cell line. The three clones with the greatest signal-to-noise, best stability of response with passage number, and best adhesion to PDL precoated plates (Becton Dickinson) were expanded and characterized.
[0286] N-type Electrophysiology in Recombinant Cells. For electrophysiological recording, the cells expressing αlb, β3 and α2δ subunits were seeded on 35 -mm culture Petri dishes at a density of approximately 104 cells/dish and kept in an incubator for up to three days for subsequent recordings. For recordings, the dishes were positioned on the stage of an inverted microscope (Nikon, Eclipse E600, Japan) and superfused with a bath solution comprised OfBaCl2 (11 mM), MgCl2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (10 mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH. Whole-cell voltage-clamp recordings were made using conventional patch- clamp techniques (Hamill et al., Pβuegers Arch. 391: 85-100 (1981)) at room temperature (22-24 0C). The patch-clamp pipettes were pulled from WPI, thick-walled borosilicate glass (WPI, Sarasota, FL). Currents were recorded using an Axopatch 200A amplifier (Axon Instruments, Union City, CA) and were leak-subtracted (P/4), low-pass filtered (1 kHz, 4-pole Bessel), digitized (20-50-μs intervals), and stored using Digidata 1200 B interface and Pclampδ.O/Clampex software (Axon Instruments, Union City, CA). The pipettes were back-filled with internal solution containing CsCl (HOmM), MgCl2 (3 mM), EGTA (3 mM), HEPES (40 mM), Mg-ATP (4 mM), Na2GTP (0.5 mM), and adjusted to pH 7.2 with CsOH. The pipette resistance ranged from 2 to 3 MOhm and was compensated by 75-80 % by the built-in electronic circuitry.
[0287] Currents were elicited by stepping from a holding potential of -90 mV to 0 mV for 20 ms every 20 sec. At the -90 mV membrane voltage about 50% of channels were in the inactivated state, and thus contact with a blocker would involve interaction with both resting and inactivated channels. Every drug was applied at 3 to 4 concentrations increasing in a cumulative manner. Fractional inhibition levels in steady-state were used to draw the partial inhibition concentration curves to get the IC50 (i.e. concentration causing 50% reduction in the size of the response) values at -90 mV.
[0288] Stock solutions of each test compound were prepared using DMSO. Serial dilutions to desired concentrations were done with bath solution; concentration of DMSO in final solutions was 0.1 %. Drugs were applied by gravity flow using a plane multi-barrel array shooter positioned 0.5 mm apart from the cell.
[0289] All curve fittings were carried out using Origin software (version 5.0, Microcal). A Hill equation was fit to the concentration- inhibition curves to determine IC50 values.
[0290] N-type Electrophysiology in Neuronal Cells. To determine dissociation constants in resting versus inactivated state for N-type calcium channels, neuronal cells that endogenously express N-type calcium channels can be used. For electrophysiological recording, the neuronal cells expressing N-type calcium channels are seeded on 35 -mm culture Petri dishes at a density of approximately 104 cells/dish and kept in an incubator for up to three days for subsequent recordings. For recordings, the dishes are positioned on the stage of an inverted microscope (Nikon, Eclipse E600, Japan) and superfused with a bath solution comprised OfBaCl2 (11 mM), MgCl2 (1.5 mM), HEPES (10 mM), TEA chloride (120 mM), glucose (1O mM) adjusted to pH 7.4 with KOH. Whole-cell voltage-clamp recordings are made using conventional patch-clamp techniques (Hamill et ah, Pfluegers Arch. 391: 85-100 (1981)) at room temperature (22-24 0C). The patch-clamp pipettes are pulled from WPI, thick-walled borosilicate glass (WPI, Sarasota, FL). Currents are recorded using an Axopatch 200A amplifier (Axon Instruments, Union City, CA) and leak-subtracted (P/4), low-pass filtered (1 kHz, 4-pole Bessel), digitized (20-50-μs intervals), and stored using Digidata 1200 B interface and Pclampδ.O/Clampex software (Axon Instruments, Union City, CA). The pipettes are back-filled with internal solution containing CsCl (HOmM), MgCl2 (3 mM), EGTA (3 mM), HEPES (40 mM), Mg-ATP (4 mM), Na2GTP (0.5 mM), and adjusted to pH 7.2 with CsOH. The pipette resistance ranges from 2 to 3 MOhm and is compensated by 75-80 % by the built-in electronic circuitry.
[0291] Currents are elicited by stepping from a holding potential of -90 mV to 0 mV for 20 ms every 10 sec. At the -90 mV membrane voltage a proportion of channels is in the inactivated state, and thus contact with a blocker would involve interaction with both resting and inactivated channels. This protocol is used as a first tier screen. For dissection of two components of inhibition (resting block with the apparent dissociation constant Kr and inactivated state block with K1), steady-state inactivation curves are collected using a double-pulse protocol. Three-second long depolarizing pre-pulse incrementing in 10 mV steps is followed by a 10 ms test pulse to 0 mV.
[0292] Stock solutions of each test compound are prepared using DMSO. Serial dilutions to desired concentrations are done with bath solution; concentration of DMSO in final solutions is 0.1 %. Drugs are applied by gravity flow using a plane multi-barrel array shooter positioned ~1 mm apart from the cell.
[0293] All curve fittings can be carried out using Origin software (version 5.0, Microcal). A Hill equation is used to fit the concentration-response curves and to determine IC50 values. A Boltzman equation is used to fit inactivation curves, returning half- inactivation voltage, Vo 5, slope p and the amplitude of current at the most negative voltage where eventually all channels are in the resting state. These parameters are used to calculate the apparent dissociation constants: Kr = ((Ab/Ac)/(l-(Ab/Ac))*[b]) where [b] is the drug concentration, Ac is the maximum test current amplitude in control conditions and Ab is the maximum test current amplitude in the presence of a blocker; K1 = [b]/((exp(-(dx/p))*(l+([b]/Kr)) - 1) where dx is the difference between half-inactivation voltage Vo 5 in the presence and absence of drug and p is the slope.
In vivo Pharmacology
[0294] The compounds of the present invention can be tested for in vivo anticonvulsant activity after Lv., p.o., or i.p. injection using any of a number of anticonvulsant tests in mice, including the maximum electroshock seizure test (MES). Maximum electroshock seizures are induced in male NSA mice weighing between 15-20 g and in male Sprague-Dawley rats weighing between 200-225 g by application of current (for mice: 50 mA, 60 pulses/sec, 0.8 msec pulse width, 1 sec duration, D. C; for rats: 99 mA, 125 pulses/sec, 0.8 msec pulse width, 2 sec duration, D. C.) using a Ugo Basile ECT device (Model 7801). Mice are restrained by gripping the loose skin on their dorsal surface and saline-coated corneal electrodes are held lightly against the two corneae. Rats are allowed free movement on the bench top and ear-clip electrodes are used. Current is applied and animals are observed for a period of up to 30 seconds for the occurrence of a tonic hindlimb extensor response. A tonic seizure is defined as a hindlimb extension in excess of 90 degrees from the plane of the body. Results can be treated in a quantal manner.
[0295] The compounds can be tested for their antinociceptive activity in the formalin model as described in Hunskaar, S., O. B. Fasmer, and K. Hole, J Neurosci. Methods 14: 69-76 (1985). Male Swiss Webster NIH mice (20-30 g; Harlan, San Diego, CA) can be used in all experiments. Food is withdrawn on the day of experiment. Mice are placed in Plexiglass jars for at least 1 hour to acclimate to the environment. Following the acclimation period mice are weighed and given either the compound of interest administered i.p. or p.o., or the appropriate volume of vehicle (10 % Tween- 80) as control. Fifteen minutes after the i.p. dosing, and 30 minutes after the p.o. dosing mice are injected with formalin (20 μL of 5% formaldehyde solution in saline) into the dorsal surface of the right hind paw. Mice are transferred to the Plexiglass jars and monitored for the amount of time spent licking or biting the injected paw. Periods of licking and biting are recorded in 5 -minute intervals for 1 hour after the formalin injection. All experiments are done in a blinded manner during the light cycle. The early phase of the formalin response is measured as licking / biting between 0-5 minutes, and the late phase is measured from 15-50 minutes. Differences between vehicle and drug treated groups can be analyzed by one-way analysis of variance (ANOVA). A P value <0.05 is considered significant. Compounds are considered to be efficacious for treating acute and chronic pain if they have activity in blocking both the early and second phase of formalin- induced paw-licking activity.
[0296] Compounds can be tested for their potential to treat chronic pain (i.e., antiallodynic and antihyperalgesic activities) using the Chung model of peripheral neuropathy (Kim and Chung, Pain 50: 355-363 (1992)). Male Sprague-Dawley rats weighing between 200-225 g are anesthetized with halothane (1-3 % in a mixture of 70 % air and 30 % oxygen), and their body temperature controlled during anesthesia through use of a homeothermic blanket. A 2-cm dorsal midline incision is then made at the L5 and L6 level, and the para-vertebral muscle groups retracted bilaterally. L5 and L6 spinal nerves are then exposed, isolated, and tightly ligated with 6-0 or 7-0 silk suture. A sham operation is performed exposing the contralateral L5 and L6 spinal nerves, without ligating, as a negative control.
[0297] Tactile Allodynia: Sensitivity to non-noxious mechanical stimuli can be measured in animals to assess tactile allodynia. Rats are transferred to an elevated testing cage with a wire mesh floor and allowed to acclimate for five to ten minutes. A series of von Frey monofilaments are applied to the plantar surface of the hindpaw to determine the animal's withdrawal threshold. The first filament used possesses a buckling weight of 9.1 gms (.96 log value) and is applied up to five times to see if it elicits a withdrawal response. If the animal has a withdrawal response, then the next lightest filament in the series would be applied up to five times to determine if it also could elicit a response. This procedure is repeated with subsequent lesser filaments until there is no response and the identity of the lightest filament that elicits a response is recorded. If the animal does not have a withdrawal response from the initial 9.1 gms filament, then subsequent filaments of increased weight are applied until a filament elicits a response and the identity of this filament is recorded. For each animal, three measurements are made at every time point to produce an average withdrawal threshold determination. Tests can be performed prior to, and at 1, 2, 4 and 24 hours post drug administration.
[0298] Mechanical Hyperalgesia: Sensitivity to noxious mechanical stimuli can be measured in animals using the paw pressure test to assess mechanical hyperalgesia. In rats, hind paw withdrawal thresholds ("PWT"), measured in grams, in response to a noxious mechanical stimulus are determined using an analgesymeter (Model 7200, commercially available from Ugo Basile of Italy), as described in Stein (Biochemistry & Behavior 31: 451-455 (1988)). The rat's paw is placed on a small platform, and weight is applied in a graded manner up to a maximum of 250 grams. The endpoint is taken as the weight at which the paw is completely withdrawn. PWT is determined once for each rat at each time point. PWT can be measured only in the injured paw, or in both the injured and non-injured paw. In one non-limiting embodiment, mechanical hyperalgesia associated with nerve injuty induced pain (neuropathic pain) can be assessed in rats. Rats are tested prior to surgery to determine a baseline, or normal, PWT. Rats are tested again 2 to 3 weeks post-surgery, prior to, and at different times after (e.g. 1, 3, 5 and 24 hr) drug administration. An increase in PWT following drug administration indicates that the test compound reduces mechanical hyperalgesia. Pharmaceutical Compositions
[0299] Although a compound of the present invention may be administered to a mammal in the form of a raw chemical without any other components present, the compound is preferably administered as part of a pharmaceutical composition containing the compound combined with a suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Such a carrier can be selected from pharmaceutically acceptable excipients and auxiliaries.
[0300] Pharmaceutical compositions within the scope of the present invention include all compositions where a compound of the present invention is combined with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In a preferred embodiment, the compound is present in the composition in an amount that is effective to achieve its intended therapeutic purpose. While individual needs may vary, a determination of optimal ranges of effective amounts of each compound is within the skill of the art. Typically, the compounds may be administered to a mammal, e.g., a human, orally at a dose of from about 0.0025 to about 1500 mg per kg body weight of the mammal, or an equivalent amount of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof, per day to treat, prevent or ameliorate the particular disorder. A useful oral dose of a compound of the present invention administered to a mammal is from about 0.0025 to about 50 mg per kg body weight of the mammal, or an equivalent amount of the pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof. For intramuscular injection, the dose is typically about one-half of the oral dose.
[0301] A unit oral dose may comprise from about 0.01 to about 50 mg, and preferably about 0.1 to about 10 mg, of the compound. The unit dose can be administered one or more times daily, e.g., as one or more tablets or capsules, each containing from about 0.01 to about 50 mg of the compound, or an equivalent amount of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or solvate thereof.
[0302] A pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered to any animal that may experience the beneficial effects of a compound of the present invention. Foremost among such animals are mammals, e.g., humans and companion animals, although the invention is not intended to be so limited.
[0303] A pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by any means that achieves its intended purpose. For example, administration can be by the oral, parenteral, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, transdermal, intranasal, transmucosal, rectal, intravaginal or buccal route, or by inhalation. The dosage administered and route of administration will vary, depending upon the circumstances of the particular subject, and taking into account such factors as age, health, and weight of the recipient, condition or disorder to be treated, kind of concurrent treatment, if any, frequency of treatment, and the nature of the effect desired.
[0304] In one embodiment, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered orally and is formulated into tablets, dragees, capsules or an oral liquid preparation. In one embodiment, the oral formulation comprises extruded multiparticulates comprising the compound of the invention.
[0305] Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered rectally, and is formulated in suppositories.
[0306] Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by injection. [0307] Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered transdermally.
[0308] Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by inhalation or by intranasal or transmucosal administration.
[0309] Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can be administered by the intravaginal route.
[0310] A pharmaceutical composition of the present invention can contain from about 0.01 to 99 percent by weight, and preferably from about 0.25 to 75 percent by weight, of active compound(s).
[0311] A method of the present invention, such as a method for treating, preventing, or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels in an animal in need thereof, can further comprise administering a second therapeutic agent to the animal in combination with a compound of the present invention. In one embodiment, the other therapeutic agent is administered in an effective amount.
[0312] Effective amounts of the other therapeutic agents are known to those skilled in the art. However, it is well within the skilled artisan's purview to determine the other therapeutic agent's optimal effective-amount range.
[0313] A compound of the present invention (i.e., the first therapeutic agent) and the second therapeutic agent can act additively or, in one embodiment, synergistically. In one embodiment, a compound of the present invention is administered concurrently with a second therapeutic agent; for example, a single composition comprising both an effective amount of a compound of any of Formulae I-XIII, and an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent can be administered. Accordingly, the present invention further provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a combination of a compound of the present invention, the second therapeutic agent, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Alternatively, a first pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of a compound of any of Formulae I-XIII and a second pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent can be concurrently administered. In another embodiment, an effective amount of a compound of the present invention is administered prior or subsequent to administration of an effective amount of the second therapeutic agent. In this embodiment, the compound of the present invention is administered while the second therapeutic agent exerts its therapeutic effect, or the second therapeutic agent is administered while the compound of the present invention exerts its therapeutic effect for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder or condition.
[0314] The second therapeutic agent can be an opioid agonist, a non-opioid analgesic, a non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agent, an antimigraine agent, a Cox-II inhibitor, a β-adrenergic blocker, an anticonvulsant, an antidepressant, an anticancer agent, an agent for treating addictive disorder, an agent for treating Parkinson's disease and parkinsonism, an agent for treating anxiety, an agent for treating epilepsy, an agent for treating a seizure, an agent for treating a stroke, an agent for treating a pruritic condition, an agent for treating psychosis, an agent for treating ALS, an agent for treating a cognitive disorder, an agent for treating a migraine, an agent for treating vomiting, an agent for treating dyskinesia, or an agent for treating depression, or a mixture thereof.
[0315] Examples of useful opioid agonists include, but are not limited to, alfentanil, allylprodine, alphaprodine, anileridine, benzylmorphine, bezitramide, buprenorphine, butorphanol, clonitazene, codeine, desomorphine, dextromoramide, dezocine, diampromide, diamorphone, dihydrocodeine, dihydromorphine, dimenoxadol, dimepheptanol, dimethylthiambutene, dioxaphetyl butyrate, dipipanone, eptazocine, ethoheptazine, ethylmethylthiambutene, ethylmorphine, etonitazene, fentanyl, heroin, hydrocodone, hydromorphone, hydroxypethidine, isomethadone, ketobemidone, levorphanol, levophenacylmorphan, lofentanil, meperidine, meptazinol, metazocine, methadone, metopon, morphine, myrophine, nalbuphine, narceine, nicomorphine, norlevorphanol, normethadone, nalorphine, normorphine, norpipanone, opium, oxycodone, oxymorphone, papaveretum, pentazocine, phenadoxone, phenomorphan, phenazocine, phenoperidine, piminodine, piritramide, proheptazine, promedol, properidine, propiram, propoxyphene, sufentanil, tilidine, tramadol, pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, and mixtures thereof.
[0316] In certain embodiments, the opioid agonist is selected from codeine, hydromorphone, hydrocodone, oxycodone, dihydrocodeine, dihydromorphine, morphine, tramadol, oxymorphone, pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, and mixtures thereof.
[0317] Examples of useful non-opioid analgesics include non-steroidal antiinflammatory agents, such as aspirin, ibuprofen, diclofenac, naproxen, benoxaprofen, flurbiprofen, fenoprofen, flubufen, ketoprofen, indoprofen, piroprofen, carprofen, oxaprozin, pramoprofen, muroprofen, trioxaprofen, suprofen, aminoprofen, tiaprofenic acid, fluprofen, bucloxic acid, indomethacin, sulindac, tolmetin, zomepirac, tiopinac, zidometacin, acemetacin, fentiazac, clidanac, oxpinac, mefenamic acid, meclofenamic acid, flufenamic acid, niflumic acid, tolfenamic acid, diflurisal, flufenisal, piroxicam, sudoxicam, isoxicam, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, and mixtures thereof. Examples of other suitable non-opioid analgesics include the following, non limiting, chemical classes of analgesic, antipyretic, nonsteroidal antiinflammatory drugs: salicylic acid derivatives, including aspirin, sodium salicylate, choline magnesium trisalicylate, salsalate, difiunisal, salicylsalicylic acid, sulfasalazine, and olsalazin; para aminophennol derivatives including acetaminophen and phenacetin; indole and indene acetic acids, including indomethacin, sulindac, and etodolac; heteroaryl acetic acids, including tolmetin, diclofenac, and ketorolac; anthranilic acids (fenamates), including mefenamic acid, and meclofenamic acid; enolic acids, including oxicams (piroxicam, tenoxicam), and pyrazolidinediones (phenylbutazone, oxyphenthartazone); and alkanones, including nabumetone. For a more detailed description of the NSAIDs, see Paul A. Insel, Analgesic Antipyretic and Antiinflammatory Agents and Drugs Employed in the Treatment of Gout, in Goodman & Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics 617-57 (Perry B. Molinhoff and Raymond W. Ruddon eds., 9th ed 1996) and Glen R. Hanson, Analgesic, Antipyretic and Anti Inflammatory Drugs in Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy VoI II 1196-1221 (A.R. Gennaro ed. 19th ed. 1995) which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties. Suitable Cox- II inhibitors and 5 -lipoxygenase inhibitors, as well as combinations thereof, are described in U.S. Patent No. 6,136,839, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. Examples of useful Cox II inhibitors include, but are not limited to, rofecoxib and celecoxib.
[0318] Examples of useful antimigraine agents include, but are not limited to, alpiropride, bromocriptine, dihydroergotamine, dolasetron, ergocornine, ergocorninine, ergocryptine, ergonovine, ergot, ergotamine, fiumedroxone acetate, fonazine, ketanserin, lisuride, lomerizine, methylergonovine, methysergide, metoprolol, naratriptan, oxetorone, pizotyline, propranolol, risperidone, rizatriptan, sumatriptan, timolol, trazodone, zolmitriptan, and mixtures thereof.
[0319] Examples of useful β-adrenergic blockers include, but are not limited to, acebutolol, alprenolol, amosulabol, arotinolol, atenolol, befunolol, betaxolol, bevantolol, bisoprolol, bopindolol, bucumolol, bufetolol, bufuralol, bunitrolol, bupranolol, butidrine hydrochloride, butofilolol, carazolol, carteolol, carvedilol, celiprolol, cetamolol, cloranolol, dilevalol, epanolol, esmolol, indenolol, labetalol, levobunolol, mepindolol, metipranolol, metoprolol, moprolol, nadolol, nadoxolol, nebivalol, nifenalol, nipradilol, oxprenolol, penbutolol, pindolol, practolol, pronethalol, propranolol, sotalol, sulfϊnalol, talinolol, tertatolol, tilisolol, timolol, toliprolol, and xibenolol.
[0320] Examples of useful anticonvulsants include, but are not limited to, acetylpheneturide, albutoin, aloxidone, aminoglutethimide, 4-amino-3- hydroxybutyric acid, atrolactamide, beclamide, buramate, calcium bromide, carbamazepine, cinromide, clomethiazole, clonazepam, decimemide, diethadione, dimethadione, doxenitroin, eterobarb, ethadione, ethosuximide, ethotoin, felbamate, fluoresone, gabapentin, 5-hydroxytryptophan, lamotrigine, magnesium bromide, magnesium sulfate, mephenytoin, mephobarbital, metharbital, methetoin, methsuximide, 5-methyl-5-(3- phenanthryl)-hydantoin, 3 -methyl-5 -phenylhydantoin, narcobarbital, nimetazepam, nitrazepam, oxcarbazepine, paramethadione, phenacemide, phenetharbital, pheneturide, phenobarbital, phensuximide, phenylmethylbarbituric acid, phenytoin, phethenylate sodium, potassium bromide, pregabaline, primidone, progabide, sodium bromide, solanum, strontium bromide, suclofenide, sulthiame, tetrantoin, tiagabine, topiramate, trimethadione, valproic acid, valpromide, vigabatrin, and zonisamide.
[0321] Examples of useful antidepressants include, but are not limited to, binedaline, caroxazone, citalopram, (S)-citalopram, dimethazan, fencamine, indalpine, indeloxazine hydrocholoride, nefopam, nomifensine, oxitriptan, oxypertine, paroxetine, sertraline, thiazesim, trazodone, benmoxine, iproclozide, iproniazid, isocarboxazid, nialamide, octamoxin, phenelzine, cotinine, rolicyprine, rolipram, maprotiline, metralindole, mianserin, mirtazepine, adinazolam, amitriptyline, amitriptylinoxide, amoxapine, butriptyline, clomipramine, demexiptiline, desipramine, dibenzepin, dimetacrine, dothiepin, doxepin, fluacizine, imipramine, imipramine N-oxide, iprindole, lofepramine, melitracen, metapramine, nortriptyline, noxiptilin, opipramol, pizotyline, propizepine, protriptyline, quinupramine, tianeptine, trimipramine, adrafinil, benactyzine, bupropion, butacetin, dioxadrol, duloxetine, etoperidone, febarbamate, femoxetine, fenpentadiol, fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, hematoporphyrin, hypericin, levophacetoperane, medifoxamine, milnacipran, minaprine, moclobemide, nefazodone, oxaflozane, piberaline, prolintane, pyrisuccideanol, ritanserin, roxindole, rubidium chloride, sulpiride, tandospirone, thozalinone, tofenacin, toloxatone, tranylcypromine, L-tryptophan, venlafaxine, viloxazine, and zimeldine.
[0322] Examples of useful anticancer agents include, but are not limited to, acivicin, aclarubicin, acodazole hydrochloride, acronine, adozelesin, aldesleukin, altretamine, ambomycin, ametantrone acetate, aminoglutethimide, amsacrine, anastrozole, anthramycin, asparaginase, asperlin, azacitidine, azetepa, azotomycin, batimastat, benzodepa, bicalutamide, bisantrene hydrochloride, bisnafide dimesylate, bizelesin, bleomycin sulfate, brequinar sodium, bropirimine, busulfan, cactinomycin, calusterone, caracemide, carbetimer, carboplatin, carmustine, carubicin hydrochloride, carzelesin, cedefingol, chlorambucil, cirolemycin, and cisplatin.
[0323] Therapeutic agents useful for treating or preventing an addictive disorder include, but are not limited to, methadone, desipramine, amantadine, fluoxetine, buprenorphine, an opiate agonist, 3-phenoxypyridine, or a serotonin antagonist.
[0324] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing Parkinson's disease and parkinsonism include, but are not limited to, carbidopa/levodopa, pergolide, bromocriptine, ropinirole, pramipexole, entacapone, tolcapone, selegiline, amantadine, and trihexyphenidyl hydrochloride.
[0325] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing anxiety include, but are not limited to, benzodiazepines, such as alprazolam, brotizolam, chlordiazepoxide, clobazam, clonazepam, clorazepate, demoxepam, diazepam, estazolam, flumazenil, flurazepam, halazepam, lorazepam, midazolam, nitrazepam, nordazepam, oxazepam, prazepam, quazepam, temazepam, and triazolam; non-benzodiazepine agents, such as buspirone, gepirone, ipsapirone, tiospirone, zolpicone, Zolpidem, and zaleplon; tranquilizers, such as barbituates, e.g., amobarbital, aprobarbital, butabarbital, butalbital, mephobarbital, methohexital, pentobarbital, phenobarbital, secobarbital, and thiopental; and propanediol carbamates, such as meprobamate and tybamate.
[0326] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing epilepsy or seizure include, but are not limited to, carbamazepine, ethosuximide, gabapentin, lamotrigine, phenobarbital, phenytoin, primidone, valproic acid, trimethadione, benzodiazepines, gamma-vinyl GABA, acetazolamide, and felbamate.
[0327] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing stroke include, but are not limited to, anticoagulants such as heparin, agents that break up clots such as streptokinase or tissue plasminogen activator, agents that reduce swelling such as mannitol or corticosteroids, and acetylsalicylic acid.
[0328] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing a pruritic condition include, but are not limited to, naltrexone; nalmefene; danazol; tricyclics such as amitriptyline, imipramine, and doxepin; antidepressants such as those given below; menthol; camphor; phenol; pramoxine; capsaicin; tar; steroids; and antihistamines.
[0329] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing psychosis include, but are not limited to, phenothiazines such as chlorpromazine hydrochloride, mesoridazine besylate, and thoridazine hydrochloride; thioxanthenes such as chloroprothixene and thiothixene hydrochloride; clozapine; risperidone; olanzapine; quetiapine; quetiapine fumarate; haloperidol; haloperidol decanoate; loxapine succinate; molindone hydrochloride; pimozide; and ziprasidone.
[0330] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing ALS include, but are not limited to, baclofen, neurotrophic factors, riluzole, tizanidine, benzodiazepines such as clonazepan and dantrolene.
[0331] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing cognitive disorders include, but are not limited to, agents for treating or preventing dementia such as tacrine; donepezil; ibuprofen; antipsychotic drugs such as thioridazine and haloperidol; and antidepressant drugs such as those given below.
[0332] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing a migraine include, but are not limited to, sumatriptan; methysergide; ergotamine; caffeine; and beta-blockers such as propranolol, verapamil, and divalproex.
[0333] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing vomiting include, but are not limited to, 5-HT3 receptor antagonists such as ondansetron, dolasetron, granisetron, and tropisetron; dopamine receptor antagonists such as prochlorperazine, thiethylperazine, chlorpromazine, metoclopramide, and domperidone; glucocorticoids such as dexamethasone; and benzodiazepines such as lorazepam and alprazolam.
[0334] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing dyskinesia include, but are not limited to, reserpine and tetrabenazine.
[0335] Examples of useful therapeutic agents for treating or preventing depression include, but are not limited to, tricyclic antidepressants such as amitryptyline, amoxapine, bupropion, clomipramine, desipramine, doxepin, imipramine, maprotiline, nefazadone, nortriptyline, protriptyline, trazodone, trimipramine, and venlafaxine; selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors such as citalopram, (S)-citalopram, fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, paroxetine, and setraline; monoamine oxidase inhibitors such as isocarboxazid, pargyline, phenelzine, and tranylcypromine; and psychostimulants such as dextroamphetamine and methylphenidate.
[0336] A pharmaceutical composition of the present invention is preferably manufactured in a manner which itself will be known in view of the instant disclosure, for example, by means of conventional mixing, granulating, dragee-making, dissolving, extrusion, or lyophilizing processes. Thus, pharmaceutical compositions for oral use can be obtained by combining the active compound with solid excipients, optionally grinding the resulting mixture and processing the mixture of granules, after adding suitable auxiliaries, if desired or necessary, to obtain tablets or dragee cores.
[0337] Suitable excipients include fillers such as saccharides (for example, lactose, sucrose, mannitol or sorbitol), cellulose preparations, calcium phosphates (for example, tricalcium phosphate or calcium hydrogen phosphate), as well as binders such as starch paste (using, for example, maize starch, wheat starch, rice starch, or potato starch), gelatin, tragacanth, methyl cellulose, hydroxypropylmethylcellulose, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, and/or polyvinyl pyrrolidone. If desired, one or more disintegrating agents can be added, such as the above-mentioned starches and also carboxymethyl- starch, cross-linked polyvinyl pyrrolidone, agar, or alginic acid or a salt thereof, such as sodium alginate.
[0338] Auxiliaries are typically flow-regulating agents and lubricants such as, for example, silica, talc, stearic acid or salts thereof (e.g., magnesium stearate or calcium stearate), and polyethylene glycol. Dragee cores are provided with suitable coatings that are resistant to gastric juices. For this purpose, concentrated saccharide solutions may be used, which may optionally contain gum arabic, talc, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, polyethylene glycol and/or titanium dioxide, lacquer solutions and suitable organic solvents or solvent mixtures. In order to produce coatings resistant to gastric juices, solutions of suitable cellulose preparations such as acetylcellulose phthalate or hydroxypropymethyl-cellulose phthalate can be used. Dye stuffs or pigments may be added to the tablets or dragee coatings, for example, for identification or in order to characterize combinations of active compound doses.
[0339] Examples of other pharmaceutical preparations that can be used orally include push-fit capsules made of gelatin, or soft, sealed capsules made of gelatin and a plasticizer such as glycerol or sorbitol. The push-fit capsules can contain a compound in the form of granules, which may be mixed with fillers such as lactose, binders such as starches, and/or lubricants such as talc or magnesium stearate and, optionally, stabilizers, or in the form of extruded multiparticulates. In soft capsules, the active compounds are preferably dissolved or suspended in suitable liquids, such as fatty oils or liquid paraffin. In addition, stabilizers may be added.
[0340] Possible pharmaceutical preparations for rectal administration include, for example, suppositories, which consist of a combination of one or more active compounds with a suppository base. Suitable suppository bases include natural and synthetic triglycerides, and paraffin hydrocarbons, among others. It is also possible to use gelatin rectal capsules consisting of a combination of active compound with a base material such as, for example, a liquid triglyceride, polyethylene glycol, or paraffin hydrocarbon.
[0341] Suitable formulations for parenteral administration include aqueous solutions of the active compound in a water-soluble form such as, for example, a water-soluble salt, alkaline solution, or acidic solution.
Alternatively, a suspension of the active compound may be prepared as an oily suspension. Suitable lipophilic solvents or vehicles for such as suspension may include fatty oils (for example, sesame oil), synthetic fatty acid esters (for example, ethyl oleate), triglycerides, or a polyethylene glycol such as polyethylene glycol-400 (PEG-400). An aqueous suspension may contain one or more substances to increase the viscosity of the suspension, including, for example, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, sorbitol, and/or dextran. The suspension may optionally contain stabilizers.
[0342] The following examples are illustrative, but not limiting, of the compounds, compositions and methods of the present invention. Suitable modifications and adaptations of the variety of conditions and parameters normally encountered in clinical therapy and which are obvious to those skilled in the art in view of this disclosure are within the spirit and scope of the invention.
Examples
EXAMPLE 1
N-Cyclopropyl-N-piperidin-3 -yl-3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide hydrochloride (6)
Figure imgf000109_0001
[0343] N-Cyclopropyl-N-piperidin-S-yl-S- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide hydrochloride (6) was prepared as follows. NaB(O2CCHs)3H (14 g, 66 mmol, Aldrich) was added to a mixture of N-tert-butoxycarbonylpiperidine-3-one (1) (10 g, 50 mmol, Aldrich), aminocyclopropyl (2) (3 g, 52.5 mmol, Aldrich), molecular sieves (4A beads, 20 g, Aldrich) in dichloroethane (DCE, 200 mL) at 0 0C. The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 hours. The reaction mixture was quenched with MeOH (2 mL), filtered over Celite, washed with water, 2N NaOH and concentrated under vacuum to afford crude 3- (cyclopropylamino)piperidine-l-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester (3) as a colorless oil.
[0344] 3-Trifluoromethylphenylsulfonyl chloride (4) (12 g, 49 mmol, Aldrich) was added to a mixture of the crude compound 3, triethylamine (TEA, 10 mL) and dichlorome thane (DCM, 10 mL) at room temperature. The resulting mixture was heated and stirred at 37 0C for 2 days. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature, washed with water (10 mL) and then with brine, and concentrated and purified by column (silica gel) eluting with EtOAc/hexanes (3/7) to afford 3-[N-cyclopropyl-N-(3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)amino]piperidine- 1 -carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester (5) as a sticky oil (10 g, yield 45% in two steps), which was dissolved in 100 mL of 1,4-dioxane. HCl (10 mL, concentrated aq.) was added to the 1,4- dioxane solution at room temperature. The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 48 hours, and concentrated under vacuum. The residue was washed with ethyl ether, and dried to obtain the desired title compound 6 as an oil (6.5 g, 81%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.22 (d, j = 7.9 Hz, IH), 8.17 (s, IH), 8.06 (d, j = 7.8 Hz, IH), 7.90 (d, IH, j = 7.8 Hz, IH), 4.17 - 4.24 (m, IH), 3.34 - 3.38 (m, 2H), 3.22 - 3.29 (m, IH), 2.87 - 2.95 (m, IH), 1.98 - 2.18 (m, 3H), 1.68 - 1.82 (m, 2H), 1.04 - 1.09 (m, IH), 0.79 - 0.92 (m, 3H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 349 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 2
(2S) N-[I -(2-Amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N- cyclopropyl-3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (8)
Figure imgf000110_0001
6 7 8
[0345] (2S) N-[I -(2-Amino-4-methylpentanoyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclo- propyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (8) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 6 (see Example 1) (300 mg, 0.78 mmol), triethylamine (TEA, 0.5 mL), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole (HOBt) (100 mg), compound 2 (0.2g, 0.86 mmol, Adv. Chem. Tech.), and dichloromethane (DCM, 4 mL) was cooled with ice-water and treated with diisopropyl azodicarboxylate (DIC) (0.14 mL, 0.88 mmol). The resulting mixture was warmed to room temperature over 24 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0 0C and the solid was removed by filtration. The liquid was concentrated and purified by column (silica) eluting with EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to afford the BOC- protected product, which was dissolved in 1 ,4-dioxane (4 mL) and treated with HCl (4N in 1,4-dioxane 1 mL) at room temperature for 4 hours. The solvent was removed under vacuum and the residue was washed with Et2O (3 x 2mL) to give the title compound 8 as a HCl-salt (white solid, 300 mg, yield 79%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 7.90 - 8.28 (m, 4H, Ar-H), 4.15 - 4.55 (m, 2H), 3.75 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.35 - 3.45 (m, 0.5H), 3.05 - 3.15 (m, 0.5H), 2.85 - 2.95 (m, 0.5H), 2.55 - 2.65 (m, 0.5H), 1.45 - 2.15 (m, 8H), 0.75 - 1.15 (m, 10H). LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 462 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 3
(2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)- piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (10)
Figure imgf000111_0001
10
[0346] (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (10) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 6 (300 mg, 0.78 mmol), TEA (0.5 mL), HOBt (100 mg), compound 9 (0.22g, 0.89 mmol, Fluka), and DCM (4 mL) was cooled with ice-water and treated with DIC (0.14 mL, 0.88 mmol). The resulting mixture was warmed to room temperature over 24 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0 0C and the solid was removed by filtration. The liquid was concentrated and purified by column (silica) eluting with - I l l -
EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to afford the BOC-protected product, which was dissolved in EtOAc (4 mL) and treated with HCl (2N aqueous, 1 mL) at room temperature for 4 hours. The solvent was removed under vacuum and the residue was washed with Et2O (3 x 2mL) to give the desired product 10 as a HCl-salt (white solid, 300 mg, yield 75%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 7.86 - 8.26 (m, 4H), 4.35 - 4.55 (m, 2H), 3.75 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.38 - 3.48 (m, 0.5H), 2.92 - 3.15 (m, IH), 2.60 - 2.80 (m, 3.5H, 0.5H+NCH3), 1.45 - 2.25 (m, 8H), 0.75 - 1.20 (m, 10H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 476 (M + 1).
EXAMPLE 4
(2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-ethylamino-4- methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (12)
Figure imgf000112_0001
11 12
[0347] (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-ethylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (12) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 6 (300 mg, 0.78 mmol), TEA (0.5 mL), HOBt (100 mg), compound 11 (0.26g, 0.9 mmol, Chem-Impex), and DCM (4 mL) was cooled with ice-water and treated with DIC (0.14 mL, 0.88 mmol). The resulting mixture was warmed to room temperature over 24 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0 0C and the solid was removed by filtration. The liquid was concentrated and purified by column (silica) eluting with EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to afford the BOC-protected product, which was dissolved in 1 ,4-dioxane (4 mL) and treated with HCl (4N in 1 ,4-dioxane 1 mL) at room temperature for 4 hours. The solvent was removed under vacuum, the residue was dissolved in CHCl3 (4 mL) and neutralized with NaOH (2N aqueous, 0.5 mL). The organic layer was separated and purified by column (silica gel) eluting with EtOAc/MeOH (10/3) to give the desired product 12, which was dissolved in 0.2N aqueous HCl (10 mL) and freeze dried to obtain the HCl-salt (200 mg, yield 50%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.20 (dd, j = 7.6 & 8.2Hz, IH), 8.12 (s, IH), 8.05 (dd, j = 7.6 & 7.7 Hz, IH), 7.86 - 7.94 (m, IH), 4.35 - 4.55 (m, 2H), 3.75 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.38 - 3.48 (m, 0.5H), 2.91 - 3.19 (m, 3H), 2.59 - 2.71 (m, 0.5H), 1.35 - 2.25 (m, HH), 0.75 - 1.20 (m, 10H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 490 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 5
(2S) N-[I -(3-Amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N- cyclopropyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (14)
Figure imgf000113_0001
[0348] (2S) N-[I -(3-Amino-5-methylhexanoyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclo- propyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (14) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 6 (300 mg, 0.78 mmol), TEA (0.5 mL), HOBt (100 mg), compound 13 (0.22 g, 0.89 mmol, Peptech), and DCM (4 mL) was cooled with ice-water and treated with DIC (0.14 mL, 0.88 mmol). The resulting mixture was warmed to room temperature over 24 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to 0 0C and the solid was removed by filtration. The liquid was concentrated and purified by column (silica) eluting with EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to afford the BOC-protected product, which was dissolved in EtOAc (4 mL) and treated with HCl (2N aqueous, 1 mL) at room temperature for 4 hours. The solvent was removed under vacuum and the residue was washed with Et2O (3 x 2mL) to give the title compound 14 as a HCl-salt (white solid, 250 mg, yield 64%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 7.66 - 8.26 (m, 4H), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, IH), 3.85 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.55 - 3.65 (m, IH), 3.28 - 3.38 (m, 0.5H), 2.82 - 3.05 (m, 2H), 2.48 - 2.72 (m, 1.5H), 1.45 - 2.15 (m, 8H), 0.75 - 1.20 (m, 10H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 476 (M+l).
[0349] The following compounds can be similarly prepared:
[0350] (2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-methylamino-5-methylhexanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.02 - 8.21 (m, 3H), 7.86 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, IH), 3.85 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.45 - 3.55 (m, IH), 2.52 - 3.05 (m, 6H), 1.48 - 2.22 (m, 8H), 0.75 - 1.35 (m, HH); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 489 (M+l); and
[0351] (2R) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-methylamino-5-methylhexanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.02 - 8.21 (m, 3H), 7.85 - 7.92 (m, IH), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, IH), 3.85 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.45 - 3.55 (m, IH), 2.52 - 3.05 (m, 6H), 1.95 - 2.15 (m, 2H), 1.45 - 1.85 (m, 6H), 0.75 - 1.35 (m, HH); LC: 97.8%; MS: m/z = 489 (M+l).
EXAMPLE 6
(2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4- methylpentanoyl]piperidin-3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (16)
Figure imgf000115_0001
15 16
[0352] (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methyl- pentanoyl]piperidin-3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (16) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 8 as prepared in Example 2 (lOOmg, 0.22 mmol), compound 15 (18 mg, 0.22 mmol, Aldrich) and 4A molecular sieves (500 mg) in 2 mL of 1 ,2-dichloroethane (DCE) was shaken at room temperature for 10 minutes, and then NaB(OAc)3H (43 mg, 0.22 mmol) was charged. The resulting mixture was shaken at room temperature for 24 hours. The reaction mixture was quenched with MeOH (0.2 mL), water (2 mL) was added, and the mixture was extrated with DCM (3x4 mL). The organic layers were combined and washed with brine, dried over Na2SO3, concentrated under vacuum and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc, then EtOAc/MeOH 10/1) to give the title compound 16 as free base, which was converted to its HCl-salt by treating with HCl (1 N aquous) and drying under vacuum (white solid, 40 mg, yield 34%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.20 (d, j = 7.5 Hz, IH), 8.12 (s, IH), 8.06 (dd, j = 7.9, 8.1 Hz), IH), 7.89 (dd, j = 7.8, 7.9 Hz, IH), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, 2H), 3.75 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.45 - 3.60 (m, 0.5H), 2.55 - 3.25 (m, 3.5H), 1.45 - 2.15 (m, 1 IH), 0.75 - 1.20 (m, 16H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 532 (M+l). EXAMPLE 7
(2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-isopropylamino-4- methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (18)
Figure imgf000116_0001
17 18
[0353] (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-isopropylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (18) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 8 prepared in Example 2 (lOOmg, 0.22 mmol), compound 17 (12 mg, 0.22 mmol, Aldrich) and 4A molecular sieves (500 mg) in 2 mL of 1 ,2-dichloroethane was shaken at room temperature for 10 minutes, and then, NaB(OAc)3H (43 mg, 0.22 mmol) was charged. The resulting mixture was shaken at room temperature for 24 hours. The reaction mixture was quenched with MeOH (0.2 mL), water (2 mL) was added, and the mixture was extrated with DCM (3x4 mL). The organic layers were combined and then washed with brine, dried over Na2SO3, concentrated under vacuum and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc, then EtOAc/MeOH 10/1) to give the title compound 18 as a free base, which was converted to its HCl-salt by treating with HCl (I N aquous) and drying under vacuum (white solid, 60 mg, yield 65%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.10 - 8.22 (m, 2H), 8.06 (dd, j = 7.7, 7.8 Hz, IH), 7.91 (dd, j = 7.8, 7.9 Hz, IH), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, 2H), 3.75 - 3.95 (m, 2H), 3.35 - 3.45 (m, IH), 3.3 - 3.35 (m, IH), 2.9 - 2.95 (m, 0.5H), 2.55 - 2.64 (m, 0.5H), 1.35 - 2.15 (m, 14H), 0.75 - 1.20 (m, 10H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 504 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 8
(2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-methylcarbonylpropylamino-4- methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (20)
Figure imgf000117_0001
19 20
[0354] (2S) N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-methylcarbonylpropylamino-4- methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (20) was prepared as follows. A solution of compound 8 prepared in Example 2 (lOOmg, 0.22 mmol), compound 19 (12 mg, 0.22 mmol, Aldrich) and 4A molecular sieves (500 mg) in 2 mL of 1 ,2-dichloroethane (DCE) was shaken at room temperature for 10 minutes, and then NaB(OAc)3H (43 mg, 0.22 mmol) was charged. The resulting mixture was shaken at room temperature for 24 hours. The reaction mixture was quenched with MeOH (0.2 mL), water (2 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with DCM (3x4 mL). The organic layers were combined and washed with brine, dried over Na2SO3, concentrated under vacuum and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc, then EtOAc/MeOH 10/1) to give the title compound 20 as white solid (40 mg, yield 32%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.01 - 8.26 (m, 3H), 7.86 - 7.93 (m, IH), 5.0 - 5.15 (m, 0.4H), 4.45 - 4.55 (m, 1.2H), 3.75 - 4.35 (m, 1.3H), 2.55 - 3.45 (m, 5H), 0.75 - 2.20 (m, 26H); LC: 98%; MS: m/z = 568 (M+Na+).
EXAMPLE 9
N-(4-Fluorophenyl)-2-[3-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonylamino)- pyrrolidin-l-yl]acetamide (25)
BocH
Figure imgf000118_0001
[0355] N-(4-Fluorophenyl)-2-[3-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonylamino)- pyrrolidin-l-yl]acetamide (25) was prepared as follows. A mixture of compound 21 (1.0 g, 5.4 mmol, Aldrich), compound 22 (1 g, 5.4 mmol, Oakwood), and K2CO3 (1 g, 7.3 mmol) in 10 mL of CH3CN was shaken at room temperature for 48 hours. The organic layer was separated, concentrated and purified by column (Silica gel, EtOAc/hexanes 1/1) to give compound 23 as a white solid (1.5 g), which was dissolved in 4mL of dioxane, and treated with HCl (4 N in dioxane, 4 mL) at room temperature for 12 hours. The solvent was removed under vacuum to get compound 24 as a white solid (HCl-salt, 1.2 g). Compound 4 (0.16 g, 0.65 mmol) was added to a solution of compund 24 (0.2 g, 0.65 mmol) and TEA (0.4 mL) in 2 mL of DCM at room temperature. The resulting mixture was shaken at room temperature for 12 hours. The reaction mixture was poured on to a column (silica gel, 20 g) and washed with EtOAc/hexanes (1/1) to give the title compound 25 as a sticky oil, which was converted to its HCl-salt by dissolving in 0.5 mL of dioxane and then treating with 4N HCl in 1,4- dioxane. The solvent was removed and the salt was dried under vacuum at 50 0C for 24 hours (0.15 g, yield 48%). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.11-8.14 (m, 2H), 7.96 (d, IH, 7.9 Hz), 7.80 (dd, IH, 7.8 & 8.5 Hz), 7.52- 7.56 (m, 2H), 7.01-7.05 (m, 2H), 4.21 (s, 2H), 3.5-4.0 (m, 5H), 2.18-2.28 (m, IH), 1.9-2.0 (m, IH); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 446 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 10
N-Cyclopropyl-N-( 1 - {3-[bis-(4- fluorophenyl)amino]propyl}piperidin-3-yl)-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (27)
Figure imgf000119_0001
[0356] a) Compound 26 was prepared as follows: A 250-mL round bottom flask was charged with Pd2(dba)3 (100 mg), a ligand (300 mg; Aldrich), and Cs2CO3 (2.0 g), followed by tert-butanol (25 mL) and 1,4-dioxane (50 mL). After the mixture was stirred for 5 minutes, 4-fiuoroaniline (1.0 g, 4.5 mmol) and compound 28 (0.6 g, 5.4 mmol) were added to the flask. The flask was then flushed with argon, heated, and stirred at 1000C for 15 hours. When the reaction was complete, the flask was removed from the heat and allowed to cool to ambient temperature. The residue was concentrated under vacuum and purified by flash silica column chromatography isocratically (ethyl acetate/ hexanes, 1:9) to give compound 29 as a yellow oil (0.7 g, yield 70%).
Figure imgf000120_0001
[0357] b) A 50-mL round bottom flask was charged with compound 29 (0.4 g, 1.95 mmol) and compound 30 (0.6 mL, 2.3 mmol; Aldrich) in DMF (6 mL). The mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 5 minutes, and then NaH (60 mg, 60% in mineral oil) was added. The reaction mixture was heated to 7O0C for 4 hours. When the reaction was complete, the mixture was quenched with water (20 mL), transferred to an extraction funnel, and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 20 mL). The organic layers were combined and dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash silica column chromatography isocratically (ethyl acetate/ hexanes, 3:100) to give compound 31 as a colorless oil (0.5 g, yield 98%).
Figure imgf000120_0002
[0358] c) In a 50 mL vial, compound 31 was re-dissolved in acetonitrile (10 mL) at ambient temperature, and one mL of HF (48% aq.) was added. The vial was then shaken at ambient temperature for 2 hours. When the reaction was complete, the reaction mixture was neutralized with 2N aq. NaOH and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 10 mL). The solvents were removed in vacuuo to leave the product 32 as a colorless oil. The product was used in the next step without further purification.
Figure imgf000121_0001
[0359] d) In a 50-mL vial, the crude product 32 (0.3 g, 1.1 mmol) was dissolved in DCM (5 mL) and triethylamine (TEA) (0.2 mL). MeSO2Cl (0.12 mL, 1.5 mmol) was added to the reaction mixture and the mixture was shaken at ambient temperature for 12 hours. When the reaction was complete, the product was purified by flash silica column chromatography isocratically with ethyl acetate/hexanes (1:4), to afford compound 26 as a colorless oil (0.35 g, yield 92%).
Figure imgf000121_0002
[0360] N-(I- {3-[Bis-(4-fluorophenyl)amino]propyl}piperidin-3-yl)-N- isopropyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (27) was prepared by shaking a mixture of compound 6 (0.2 g, 0.5 mmol), compound 26 (150 mg, 0.44 mmol), TEA (0.2 mL) and K2CO3 (1 g, 7.2 mmol) in CH3CN (2 mL) at 70 0C for 16 hours. After cooling the mixture to room temperature, the mixture was diluted with DCM (4 mL) and loaded to a column (Silica gel, EtOAc/hexane 3/7) to obtain the title compound 27 as a white solid (100 mg, yield 38%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.15 (s, IH), 8.05 (d, IH, 7.9Hz), 7.82 (d, IH, 7.2Hz), 7.65 (dd, IH, 7.8, 7.9 Hz), 6.88 - 7.0 (m, 8H), 3.95 - 4.0 (m, IH), 3.65 - 3.68 (m, 2H), 2.75 - 2.84 (m, 2H), 2.28 - 2.96 (m, 2H), 1.96 - 2.05 (m, 2H), 1.52 - 1.76 (m, 7H), 1.04 - 1.08 (m, IH), 0.72 - 0.84 (m, 3H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 596 (M+ 1).
EXAMPLE 11
N-Cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -isobutylaminopropionyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (35)
N-Cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -isopropylaminopropionyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (36)
N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-methoxyethylamino)propionyl]piperidin- 3-yl} -3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfbnamide (37)
N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-hydroxyethylamino)propionyl]piperidin- 3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (38)
Figure imgf000122_0001
6 33 34 ia: isobutylamine; ib: isopropylamine; ic: 2-methoxyethylamine; id: ethanolamine
Figure imgf000123_0001
[0361] General procedure for compounds 35-38: Compound 33 (0.4 g, 4.4 mmol) was added to a solution of compound 6 (1.5 g, 3.9 mmol) and TEA (2 mL) in DCM (2 OmL) at -20 0C. The resulting mixture was warmed to room temperature over 2 hours and quenched with water. The organic layer was separated, concentrated and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc/Hexanes 3/7 and 1/1) to obtain compound 34 as an oil (1.1 g, 70%). A mixture of compound 34 (200 mg, 0.5 mmol) and the corresponding amine (ia-id, 1.5eq, Aldrich) in EtOH (0.5 mL) was heated in a sealed tube at 90 0C for 16 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was diluted with DCM (2 mL) and loaded to a column (silica gel, EtOAc/Hexane 1/1, EtOAc, and EtOAc/MeOH 9/1) to afford the desired product as free base, which was converted to its HCl-salt by treating with HCl (I N aqueous) and drying under vacuum.
[0362] N-Cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-isobutylaminopropionyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (35) (100 mg, 44%, white solid): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.19 (br, IH), 8.12 - 8.15 (m, IH), 8.02 - 8.07 (m, IH), 7.85 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.48 - 4.55 (m, IH), 3.81 - 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.35 (br, IH), 2.83 - 2.94 (m, 5.5H), 2.50 - 2.56 (m, 0.5H), 1.70 - 2.1 (m, 7H), 0.75 - 1.18 (m, 10H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 476 (M+ 1). [0363] N-Cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -isopropylaminopropionyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (36) (60 mg, 25%, white solid): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.17 - 8.21 (m, IH), 8.14 (br, IH), 8.01 - 8.06 (m, IH), 7.85 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.48 - 4.54 (m, IH), 3.81 - 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.41 - 3.44 (m, IH), 3.25 - 3.27 (m, IH), 2.95 - 3.02 (m, 0.5H), 2.81 - 2.89 (m, 3H), 2.50 - 2.52 (m, 0.5H), 1.96 - 2.12 (m, 2H), 1.42 - 1.82 (m, 3H), 1.37 (d, 6H, 6.6Hz), 0.8 - 1.2 (m, 4H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 462 (M+l).
[0364] N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-methoxyethylamino)propionyl]piperidin- 3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (37) (90 mg, 38%, white solid): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): 5 8.18 - 8.21 (m, IH), 8.12 - 8.15 (m, IH), 8.01 - 8.06 (m, IH), 7.86 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.48 - 4.54 (m, IH), 3.81 - 3.92 (m, 2H), 3.65 - 3.71 (m, 2H), 3.43 - 3.47 (m, 3H), 3.25 - 3.32 (m, 4H), 2.94 - 3.02 (m, 0.5H), 2.82 - 2.90 (m, 3H), 2.48 - 2.57 (m, 0.5H), 1.95 - 2.11 (m, 2H), 1.42 - 1.82 (m, 3H), 0.8 - 1.2 (m, 4H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 478 (M+l).
[0365] N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-hydroxyethylamino)propionyl]-piperidin- 3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfbnamide (38) (150 mg, 62%, white solid): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.21 (dd, IH, 7.0 & 7.9Hz), 8.16 (d, IH, 8.6Hz), 8.04 (dd, IH, 7.8 & 8.2Hz), 7.86 - 7.91 (m, IH), 4.48 - 4.54 (m, IH), 3.81 - 3.92 (m, 4H), 3.34 - 3.39 (m, 2H), 3.18 - 3.22 (m, 2H), 2.94 - 3.02 (m, 0.5H), 2.82 - 2.92 (m, 3H), 2.50 - 2.57 (m, 0.5H), 1.95 - 2.11 (m, 2H), 1.42 - 1.82 (m, 3H), 0.8 - 1.2 (m, 4H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 464 (M+l).
EXAMPLE 12
N-Cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(2-isobutylaminoacetyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (41)
Figure imgf000125_0001
39 40 41
[0366] N-Cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-isobutylaminoacetyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide (41) was prepared as follows. Compound 39 (0.6 g, 5.4 mmol, Aldrich) was added to a solution of compound 6 (1.5 g, 3.9 mmol) and TEA (2 mL) in DCM (20 mL) at room temperature over 10 minutes. The reaction was then quenched with water (4 mL) and the organic layer was separated, concentrated and purified by column (silica gel, EtAOc/hexanes 1/1) to give compound 40 as a colorless oil (1.2 g, 70%).
[0367] A mixture of compound 40 (100 mg, 0.24 mmol), isobutylamine (ia, Aldrich, 70 mg, 2.0 eq.) and TEA (1 mL) in DMF (1 mL) was shaken at 75 0C for 10 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was purified by column (silica gel, DCM/MeOH 100/15) to give the title compound 41 as a free base (100 mg, 48%, white solid). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): δ 8.14(d, IH, 11.9Hz), 8.09 (dd, IH, 8.7 & 9.2Hz), 7.88 (dd, IH, 7.8 & 8.2Hz), 7.72 (dd, IH, 7.7 & 7.9Hz), 4.48 - 4.54 (m, IH), 3.68 - 3.82 (m, 2H), 3.42 - 3.52 (m, 2H), 3.08 - 3.15 (m, 0.5H), 2.78 - 2.9 (m, IH), 2.38 - 2.48 (m, 2.5H), 1.75 - 2.08 (m, 5H), 1.42 - 1.82 (m, 2H), 0.96 (d, 6H, 6.6Hz), 0.88 - 0.92 (m, IH), 0.74 - 0.82 (m, 3H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 462 (M+l). EXAMPLE 13
2- {3 - [Cyclopropyl-(3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)-amino] - piperidin- 1 -yl} -N-isobutyl-acetamide (42)
2- {3-[Cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)amino]- piperidin- 1 -yl} -N-(4-fluorophenyl)-acetamide (43)
Figure imgf000126_0001
La: 2-Chloro-N-isobutyl-acetamide (prepared as shown below); Lb: 2- Chloro-N-(4-fluorophenyl)-acetamide (Oakwood)
[0368] General procedure for preparing compounds 42 and 43: A mixture of compound 6 (100 mg, 0.26 mmol), compound La or Lb (0.3 mmol) and K2CO3 (200 mg) in DMF (1 mL) was shaken at 40 0C for 16 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was quenched with water, extracted with CHCl3, concentrated and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc/hexanes 1/1) to give the desired product as a free base. The free base was converted to its HCl-salt by treating with HCl (I N aqueous) and drying under vacuum.
[0369] 2-Chloro-N-isobutyl-acetamide (La) was prepared by adding compound 39 (1.2 g, 17.8 mmol, 1.2 eq.) to a solution of isobutylamine (1.6 g, 1.0 eq., Aldrich) and TEA (2 mL) in DCM (20 mL) at 0 °C. The reaction mixture was warmed to room temperature over 3 hours and then quenched with water (6 mL), washed with brine (4 mL), concentrated and purified by column (silica gel, EtOAc/hexanes 1/9) to give compound La as a colorless oil (2 g, 62%).
[0370] 2-{3-[Cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)amino]- piperidin-l-yl}-N-isobutyl-acetamide (42) (100 mg, 83%, white solid): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 8.22 (d, IH, 8.1Hz), 8.18 (s, IH), 8.07 (d, IH, 7.9Hz), 7.91 (dd, IH, 7.8 & 7.9Hz), 4.32 - 4.39 (m, IH), 4.02 (s, 2H), 3.53 - 3.60 (m, 2H), 3.36 - 3.42 (m, IH), 3.02 - 3.12 (m, 3H), 1.98 - 2.1 (m, 3H), 1.65 - 1.88 (m, 3H), 1.04 - 1.09 (m, IH), 0.95 (d, 6H, 6.6Hz), 0.84 - 0.92 (m, 3H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 462 (M+l).
[0371] 2- {3-[Cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)amino]- piperidin-l-yl}-N-(4-fluorophenyl)acetamide (43) (120 mg, 92%, off-white solid, free base): 1U NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.0 (br, IH, NH), 8.15 (s, IH), 8.03 (d, IH, 7.9Hz), 7.83 (d, IH, 7.9Hz), 7.55 - 7.61 (m, 3H), 7.03 - 7.07 (m, 2H), 4.02 - 4.19 (m, IH), 3.13 - 3.21 (m, 2H), 2.88 - 2.96 (m, 2H), 2.46 - 2.54 (m, IH), 2.14 - 2.21 (m, IH), 1.96 - 1.99 (m, IH), 1.79 - 1.83 (m, IH), 1.63 - 1.71 (m, 3H), 1.04 - 1.09 (m, IH), 0.74 - 0.85 (m, 3H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 500 (M+l).
EXAMPLE 14
N-Cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(4-methoxybenzylamino)acetyl]-piperidin-3- yl} -3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (44)
N-Cyclopropyl-N-(l-{2-[(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)amino]acetyl}- piperidin-3-yl)-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (45)
Figure imgf000128_0001
39 40 44 45
[0372] Compound 40 was prepared as shown in Example 12. Compound 44 was prepared as follows. A mixture of compound 40 (100 mg, 0.24 mmol), 4-methoxy-benzylamine (ie, Aldich, 70 mg, 2.0 eq.) and TEA (1 mL) in DMF (1 mL) was shaken at 75 0C for 10 hours. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction mixture was purified by column (silica gel, DMC/MeOH 100/15) to give the title compound 44 as a free base (yield 70%, white solid). 1R NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD, HCl-salt): δ 8.12 (d, IH, 7.7 Hz), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.02-8.06 (m, IH), 7.86-7.91 (m, IH), 7.42-7.5 (m, 2H), 7.02-7.05 (m, 2H), 4.42-4.48 (m, IH), 4.0-4.22 (m, 4H), 3.8-3.85 (m, 4H), 3.68-3.72 (m, IH), 2.9-3.0 (m, 1.5H), 2.58-2.62 (m, 0.5H), 1.96-2.1 (m, 2H), 1.45-1.85 (m, 3H), 0.8-1.1 (m, 4H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 526 (M+l).
[0373] N-Cyclopropyl-N-(l-{2-[(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)amino]acetyl}- piperidin-3-yl)-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide (45) was prepared accordingly using 3-(aminomethyl)pyridine (if, Aldrich). The title compound 45 was obtained as a free base (yield 40%, white solid). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD, HCl-salt): δ 9.14-9.18 (m, IH), 8.98-9.03 (m, IH), 8.86-8.9 (m, IH), 8.04-8.24 (m, 4H), 7.86-7.92 (m, IH), 4.58-4.63 (m, 2H), 4.18-4.42 (m, 3H), 3.68-3.85 (m, 2H), 2.9-3.0 (m, 1.5H), 2.58-2.72 (m, 0.5H), 1.96- 2.1 (m, 2H), 1.45-1.85 (m, 3H), 0.8-1.1 (m, 4H); LC: 100%; MS: m/z = 497 (M+l). EXAMPLE 15
[0374] Compounds of the invention have been tested in the calcium mobilization and/or electrophysiological assay for N-type calcium channel blocking activity, which are described in detail above. Some compounds described have also been tested in the calcium mobilization assay for L-type calcium channel blocking activity, which is described in detail above. Representative values are presented in TABLE 2.
TABLE 2
Evaluation of the tested compounds as N-type calcium channel (NTCC) blockers and L-type calcium channel (LTCC) blockers after a calcium mobilization in vitro assay
Figure imgf000130_0001
Figure imgf000131_0001
ND = not determined
[0375] Having now fully described this invention, it will be understood by those of ordinary skill in the art that the same can be performed within a wide and equivalent range of conditions, formulations and other parameters without affecting the scope of the invention or any embodiment thereof.
[0376] Other embodiments of the invention will be apparent to those skilled in the art from consideration of the specification and practice of the invention disclosed herein. It is intended that the specification and examples be considered as exemplary only, with a true scope and spirit of the invention being indicated by the following claims. [0377] All patents and publications cited herein are fully incorporated by reference herein in their entirety.

Claims

What is Claimed Is:
1. A compound having the Formula I:
Figure imgf000133_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy; R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl; Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein
Z1 I is
Figure imgf000133_0002
Z2 is
Figure imgf000134_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000134_0002
provided that Z is Z1, Z2 or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen;
R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2- wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C;
D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is 0 or 1; y is 0 or 1 ; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is O, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; with the following provisos:
1) when Z is Z1, q is 1, m and y are 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4, R5 and R6 are each hydrogen, and R7 is benzyl substituted with chlorine at the para- position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen;
2) when Z is Z3, q is 1, D is absent, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and p is 0, then R14 is not an unsubstituted phenyl;
3) when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl; or
4) when Z is Z1, q is 1, m and y are 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4 and
R6 are each hydrogen, R5 is alkoxycarbonyl, and R7 is benzyl substituted with chlorine at the para-position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen
2. A compound having the Formula I:
Figure imgf000141_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy; R3 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3- tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl; Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000142_0001
Z2 is
Figure imgf000142_0002
Z3 is
— CR8R9- (CH2)P- D-R14
Z4 is
-SO2 R15. and
Z5 is .
Figure imgf000143_0001
R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and
R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17 or O, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group;
R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0;
R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C; D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is 0 or 1 ; y is 0 or 1 ; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; with the following provisos:
1) when Z is Z1, q is 1, m is 0, R3 is cyclohexyl, R4, R5 and
R6 are each hydrogen, and R7 is benzyl substituted with chlorine at the para- position, then R1 and R2 are not both hydrogen;
2) when Z is Z3, q is 1, D is absent, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and p is 0, then R14 is not an unsubstituted phenyl; and 3) when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl.
The compound of claim 1 , wherein R is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl,
3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
4. The compound of claim 1, wherein q is 2.
5. The compound of claim 1 , having the Formula II:
Figure imgf000149_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
6. The compound of any one of claims 1 to 5, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino.
7. The compound of claim 6, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, fluoro, chloro, trifiuoromethyl, difiuoromethyl, fiuoromethyl, cyano, nitro, methoxy and difluoromethoxy.
The compound of claim 7, wherein R1 is hydrogen and and R2 is trifiuoromethyl, or R1 and R2 are both hydrogen.
9. The compound of claim 1, having the Formula III:
Figure imgf000150_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
10. The compound of any one of claims 1, 5 or 9, wherein Z = Z1.
11. The compound of claim 10, having the Formula IV:
Figure imgf000151_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
12. The compound of claim 11, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and nitro; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
13. The compound of claim 11 , having the Formula V:
Figure imgf000152_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
14. The compound of claim 13, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and nitro; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
15. The compound of claim 13, wherein R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, unsubstituted phenyl, and phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
16. The compound of claim 15, wherein R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, isobutyl, isopentyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, and unsubstituted phenyl.
17. The compound of claim 13, wherein R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl.
18. The compound of claim 13, wherein R5 is R16-C(O)-, wherein R16 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, or phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino.
19. The compound of claim 13, wherein R5 is R16-SC>2-, wherein R16 is alkyl, phenyl unsubstituted or substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and alkylcarbonylamino, or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4- tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl.
20. The compound of claim 13, wherein R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl.
21. The compound of any one of claims 13 to 20, wherein R is hydrogen and R7 is methyl; propyl; iso-propyl; butyl; tert-butyl; sec-butyl; iso- butyl; hydroxymethyl; 1-hydroxyethyl; unsubstituted phenyl; phenyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, butyl, tert- butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dime thy lamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; unsubstituted benzyl; benzyl substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of methyl ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, butyl, tert-butyl, halogen, cyano, amino, methylamino, dimethy lamino, hydroxy, nitro, and trifluoromethyl; 1-benzyloxyethyl; cyclopentyl; cyclohexyl; cyclopentylmethyl; or cyclohexylmethyl.
22. The compound of any one of claims 13 to 20, wherein R is hydrogen,
R7 is alkyl, and R4 and R5 are independently hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl, or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl.
23. The compound of any one of claims 13 to 20, wherein R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form cyclopentyl or cyclohexyl.
24. The compound of claim 13, wherein R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group.
25. The compound of claim 13, wherein the configuration at the carbon atom to which -NR4R5 is attached is (S).
26. The compound of claim 13, having the Formula VI:
Figure imgf000155_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof, wherein:
R41 and R51 and are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; and
R18 and R19 and are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy.
27. The compound of claim 26, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
28. The compound of claim 27, wherein R41 and R51 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl.
29. The compound of claim 27, wherein R41 and R51 both are hydrogen, or R41 is hydrogen and R51 is Ci-3 alkyl.
30. The compound of any one of claims 26 to 27, wherein R18 and R19 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, C3-6 cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, Ci-3 alkylamino, di(Ci-3)alkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, halo(Ci_6)alkyl, and Ci-6 alkoxy.
31. The compound of claim 30, wherein R , 1l8β and R19 are both hydrogen, or R18 is hydrogen and R19 is methyl, tert-butyl, cyano, fluoro, methylamino, dimethylamino, trifluoromethyl, or methoxy.
32. The compound of claim 13, having the Formula VII:
Figure imgf000157_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof, wherein:
R42 and R52 and are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or R42 and R52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or a 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or C1- 3 alkyl; and
R20 and R21 are independently H or CH3.
33. The compound of claim 32, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, and diaminoalkyl; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
34. The compound of claim 32, wherein R42 and R52 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl, and hydroxyethyl.
35. The compound of claim 32, wherein R42 and R52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring selected from the group consisting of oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, 4-methylpiperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, and tetrahydropyridyl.
36. The compound of claim 32, wherein R42 and R52 are independently hydrogen, methyl or hydroxyethyl; or R42 and R52 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form 1-pyrrolidinyl, 4- thiomorpholinyl, or 4-methylpiperazinyl.
37. The compound of claim 32, wherein R20 and R21 are both H when R42 and R52 together form the 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring.
38. The compound of claim 32, wherein R42 and R52 are both hydrogen or R42 is hydrogen and R52 is alkyl.
39. The compound of any one of claims 32 to 38, wherein m is 1.
40. The compound of any one of claims 1, 5 or 9, wherein Z = Z
41. The compound of claim 40, having the Formula X:
Figure imgf000160_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
42. The compound of claim 41, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
43. The compound of claim 41, wherein R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, A is CH2 or absent, and B is CH.
44. The compound of claim 41, wherein R8 and R9 together form =0, A is CH2 or absent and B is CH, or A-B is CH=C.
45. The compound of claim 41 , wherein R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and A is O.
46. The compound of claim 41 , wherein R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, A is -C(O)-, and B is N.
47. The compound of claim 41, wherein R8 and R9 together form =0, A is CH2 or absent and B is N.
48. The compound of any one of claims 41 to 47, wherein n is 0, 1 or 2.
49. The compound of any one of claims 41 to 47, wherein R10, R11, R12, and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, Ci-6 alkyl, Ci-6 alkoxy, halo, halo(Ci.6)alkyl, hydroxy, hydroxy(Ci.6)alkyl, cyano, amino, amino(Ci.6)alkyl, Ci-3 alkylamino, and di(Ci-3)alkylamino.
50. The compound of claim 49, wherein R10 and R12 are both hydrogen.
51. The compound of any one of claims 41 to 47, wherein R11 and R13 are at the para-position of their respective phenyl rings.
52. The compound of any one of claims 1, 5 or 9, wherein Z = Z
53. The compound of claim 52, having the Formula XI:
Figure imgf000162_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
54. The compound of claim 53, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
55. The compound of claim 53, wherein R14 is selected from the group consisting of:
phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino, and preferably independently selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-propyl, tert-butyl, methoxy, ethoxy, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, methylamino, and dimethylamino; or
phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, and cyano; naphthyl; quinolinyl; and pyridyl, and preferably substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy or benzyloxy any of which is unsubstituted or substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano.
56. The compound of claim 53, wherein R14 is unsubstituted naphthyl, quinolinyl or pyridyl.
57. The compound of any one of claims 53 to 56, wherein R8 and R9 are both hydrogen when R14 is one of naphthyl; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with benzyl optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; phenyl substituted with phenoxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano; or phenyl substituted with benzyloxy optionally substituted with halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino, or cyano.
58. The compound of claim 53, wherein D is -C(O)- and R14 is
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally susbtituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; benzyl optionally susbtituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino.
59. The compound of any one of claims 53 to 56 or claim 58, wherein R8 and R9 together form =0.
60. The compound of any one of claims 53 to 56 or claim 58, wherein R and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0, and D is absent or -CH=CH-.
61. The compound of any one of claims 53 to 56 or claim 58, wherein R and R9 together form =0 and D is -C(O)-.
62. The compound of claim 53, wherein p is 0 or 1.
63. The compound of any one of claims 1, 5 or 9, wherein Z = Z4
64. The compound of claim 63, having the Formula XII:
Figure imgf000165_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
65. The compound of claim 64, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
66. The compound of claim 64, wherein R15 is phenyl or naphthyl either of which is substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino.
67. The compound of claim 64, wherein R15 is naphthyl substituted with amino, alkylamino or dialkylamino.
68. The compound of any one of claims 1, 5, or 9, wherein Z = Z5.
69. The compound of claim 68, having the Formula XIII:
Figure imgf000167_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug, or solvate thereof.
70. The compound of claim 69, wherein R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, cyano, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, nitro, amino, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; and R3 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, iso-pentyl, iso-butyl, iso-propyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, hydroxyethyl, 3-tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylmethyl, 2- tetrahydrofuranylethyl, methylsulfonamidomethyl, methylsulfonamidoethyl, aminocarbonylmethyl, and aminocarbonylethyl.
71. A compound selected from the group consisting of: N-[l-(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)piperidin-3- yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N- [l-(2-ethylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-[l-(3-amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N-cyclopropyl-3- trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N- [1 -(2 -methylcarbonylpropylamino-4-metriyl- pentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methyl-pentanoyl]- piperidin-3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [l-(2-isopropylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)- piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -amino-5 -methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 - trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N-(l - {3-[bis-(4-fluorophenyl)amino]propyl} - piperidin-3-yl)-3-trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-isobutylaminopropionyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(3 -isopropylaminopropionyl)-piperidin-3 -yl]-3 - trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfbnamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-methoxyethylamino)-propionyl]-piperidin- 3-yl} -3-trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[3-(2-hydroxyethylamino)-propionyl]-piperidin- 3-yl}-3-trifluoromethyl-benzenesulfonamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- [ 1 -(2-isobutylaminoacetyl)-piperidin-3-yl]-3- trifluoromethylbenzene-sulfonamide; 2- {3-[cyclopropyl-(3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonyl)-amino]- piperidin- 1 -yl} -N-isobutyl-acetamide;
2- {3 - [cyclopropyl-(3 -trifluoromethylbenzene- sulfonyl)amino]piperidin- 1 -yl} -N-(4-fluorophenyl)-acetamide;
N-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-[3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamino)- pyrrolidin-l-yl]acetamide;
N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(4-methoxybenzylamino)acetyl]-piperidin-3- yl} -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; N-cyclopropyl-N-(l-{2-[(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)amino]acetyl}- piperidin-3-yl)-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
72. A compound selected from the group consisting of:
(2S) N-[I -(2-amino-4-methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N- cyclopropyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(4-methyl-2-methylaminopentanoyl)- piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifiuoromethy lbenzenesulfonamide; (2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-ethylamino-4- methylpentanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-[I -(3-amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3-yl]-N- cyclopropyl-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(2-methylcarbonylpropylamino-4-methyl- pentanoyl)piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N- { 1 -[2-(3-methylbutyl)amino-4-methyl- pentanoyl]piperidin-3-yl}-3-trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[ 1 -(2-isopropylamino-4-methylpentanoyl)- piperidin-3 -yl] -3 -trifiuoromethy lbenzenesulfonamide; (2S) N-cyclopropyl-N-[l-(3-amino-5-methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3- y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide;
(2R) N-cyclopropyl-N- [1 -(3 -amino-5 -methylhexanoyl)piperidin-3 - y 1] -3 -trifluoromethylbenzenesulfonamide; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
73. A pharmaceutical composition, comprising the compound of claim 1 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
74. A method of treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to the blockade of calcium channels in a mammal suffering from said disorder, comprising administering to a mammal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration an effective amount of a compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000170_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000170_0002
Z2 is
Figure imgf000171_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 Is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000171_0002
provided that Z is Z1, Z2 or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2- wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C;
D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is 0 or 1; y is o or 1 ; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; or as set forth in any one of claims 1-72.
75. The method of claim 74, wherein a disorder responsive to the blockade of N-type calcium channels is treated, prevented or ameliorated.
76. A method for method for treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder, depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension or cardiac arrhythmia in a mammal, comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000178_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein: R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy; R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000179_0001
Z2 is
Figure imgf000179_0002
Z3 is
— CR8R9- (CH2)P- D-R14
Z4 is
-SO2 R15. and
Z5 is .
Figure imgf000180_0001
provided that Z is Z1, Z2, or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benxyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C; D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is O or 1 ; y is O or 1 ; m is O, 1, 2 or 3; n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; with the following provisos:
1) when Z is Z3, q is 1, D is absent, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and n is 0, then R14 is not an unsubstituted phenyl; or 2) when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl; or as set forth in any one of claims 1-72, to a mammal in need of such treatment, prevention or amelioration.
77. The method of claim 76, wherein the method is for treating, preventing or ameliorating pain selected from chronic pain, neuropathic pain, acute pain, and surgical pain.
78. A method of modulating calcium channels in a mammal, comprising administering to the mammal at least one compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000187_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein
Z1 I is
Figure imgf000187_0002
Z2 is
Figure imgf000188_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 Is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000188_0002
provided that Z is Z1, Z2, or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2- wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C;
D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; or as set forth in any one of claims 1 to 72.
79. The method of claim 78, wherein the N-type calcium channel is modulated.
80. A compound having the Formula I as claimed in claims 1 to 72, wherein the compound is 3H, 11C, or 14C radiolabeled, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof.
81. A method of screening a candidate compound for the ability to bind to a receptor using a radiolabeled compound of claim 80, comprising a) introducing a fixed concentration of the radiolabeled compound to the receptor to form a mixture; b) titrating the mixture with a candidate compound; and c) determining the binding of the candidate compound to said receptor.
82. Use of a compound of Formula I as claimed in claims 1 to 72 or of a compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000195_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein: R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000196_0001
Z2 is
Figure imgf000196_0002
Z3 is
:R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 is
-so, »15
; and Z5 is
,30
/
CH \
RJ1 -
provided that Z is Z1, Z2, or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen;
R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl;
R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or C1-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring; R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group;
R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy;
R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C; D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is 0 or 1 ; y is 0 or 1 ; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; with the following provisos:
1) when Z is Z3, q is 1, D is absent, R8 and R9 are both hydrogen, and n is 0, then R14 is not an unsubstituted phenyl; or 2) when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl; in the manufacture of a medicament for the treating, preventing or ameliorating stroke, neuronal damage resulting from head trauma, epilepsy, pain, migraine, a mood disorder, schizophrenia, a neurodegenerative disorder, depression, anxiety, a psychosis, hypertension or cardiac arrhythmia in a mammal.
83. Use of a compound of Formula I as claimed in claims 1 to 72 or of a compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000204_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000204_0002
Z2 is
Figure imgf000205_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 Is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000205_0002
provided that Z is Z1, Z2, or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2- wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C;
D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is 0 or 1; y is 0 or 1 ; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; with the following proviso: when Z is Z5, q is 0, and R30 and R31 are both optionally substituted phenyl, then R3 is not alkyl; in the manufacture of a medicament for the treating, preventing or ameliorating pain selected from chronic pain, neuropathic pain, acute pain, and surgical pain.
84. A method of preparing a pharmaceutical composition, comprising admixing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 1 , or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
85. Use of an effective amount of a compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000212_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein: R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy; R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonylalkyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein Z1 is
Figure imgf000213_0001
Z2 is
Figure imgf000213_0002
Z3 is
— CR8R9- (CH2)P- D-R14
Z4 is
-SO2 R15. and
Z5 is .
Figure imgf000214_0001
provided that Z is Z1, Z2 or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2-, wherein R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino;
R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and -NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C; D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; x is O or 1 ; y is O or 1 ; m is O, 1, 2 or 3; n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; or a compound as set forth in any one of claims 1-72 in the production of a medicament for treating, preventing or ameliorating a disorder responsive to a blockade of calcium channels.
86. The use of claim 85, wherein a disorder responsive to the blockade of N-type calcium channels is treated, prevented or ameliorated.
87. The use of claim 82, wherein the use is for treating, preventing or ameliorating pain selected from chronic pain, neuropathic pain, acute pain, and surgical pain.
88. Use of at least one compound of Formula I:
Figure imgf000221_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, prodrug or solvate thereof, wherein:
R1 and R2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, haloalkyl, halogen, alkoxy, haloalkoxy, cyano, nitro, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and hydroxy;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, 3 -tetrahydrofuranylalkyl, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, cyanoalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and alkoxycarbonyl;
Z is selected from the group consisting of Z1, Z2, Z3, Z4, and Z5, wherein
Z1 I is
Figure imgf000221_0002
Z2 is
Figure imgf000222_0001
Z3 is
;R8R9— (CH2)p—D-R14 .
Z4 Is
-so, ,15 and
Z5 is
Figure imgf000222_0002
provided that Z is Z1, Z2, or Z4 when R3 is hydrogen; R4 and R5 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; hydroxyalkyl; haloalkyl; mercaptoalkyl; aminoalkyl; alkylaminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, mercaptoalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminocarbonylalkyl, cycloalkyl, and phenyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy, and R5 is selected from the group consisting of hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; aminocarbonylalkyl; cycloalkyl; alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted benzyloxy, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; optionally substituted heteroaryl; R16-C(O)-; and R16-SO2- wherein
R16 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted benzyl, and 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolinyl or 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolinyl optionally substituted at the nitrogen atom with alkylcarbonyl or haloalkylcarbonyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring wherein one or more carbon atoms of the heterocyclic ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, or S, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl;
R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; hydroxyalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; haloalkyl; aminoalkyl; cycloalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; bicycloalkyl; cycloalkylalkyl, wherein one or more carbon atoms are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; benzyloxyalkyl; benzyloxybenzyl; naphthylmethyl; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; provided that when either R4 or R5 is cycloalkyl and y is 0, then at least one of R6 and R7 is other than hydrogen; or
R6 and R7 together form benzylidenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halogen, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, hydroxy, nitro, haloalkyl, and alkoxy; or
R6 and R7 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a saturated or unsaturated C3-7 cycloalkyl ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, amino, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and =0, wherein one or more carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring are optionally replaced with NR17, O, S, or SO2, wherein R17 is hydrogen or Ci-3 alkyl, to form a heterocyclic ring; or wherein two adjacent carbon atoms of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring can form a bridge -O- to form a bicyclic ring; or wherein one carbon atom of the C3-7 cycloalkyl ring is linked to a heterocyclic ring to form a spirocyclic ring;
R7 is hydrogen; R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, or hydroxyalkyl; and R5 and R6 together form a bridge -CH2-CH2-CH2- or -CH2-CHG1-CHG2-CH2-, wherein G1 and G2 are both hydrogen or together with the carbon atoms to which they are attached form a fused phenyl group; R32 are R33 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, and alkoxyalkyl; or
R33 is hydrogen and R32 is hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; or
R32 and R33 together with the carbon atom to which they are attached form a C3-7 cycloalkyl ring; or
R32 and R4 together with the carbon and nitrogen atoms to which they are attached, respectively, form a 4-, 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic ring optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, alkyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R33 is hydrogen, hydroxy, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, or alkoxyalkyl; and R5, R6 and R7 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, haloalkyl, aminoalkyl, carboxy, and alkoxycarbonyl; R8 and R9 are both hydrogen or together form =0; R10, R11, R12 and R13 are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; R14 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, and dialkylamino; quinolinyl; pyridyl; phenyl substituted with phenyl, benzyl, phenoxy, or benzyloxy, wherein each phenyl ring is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalkyl, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, amino and cyano; alkyl optionally substituted with hydroxy; and
-NR14aR14b, wherein R14a and R14b are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen; alkyl; aryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; benzyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy; and heteroarylalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, aminoalkyl, alkylamino, dialkylamino, alkoxycarbonyl, and haloalkoxy;
R15 is selected from the group consisting of phenyl or naphthyl, either of which is optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, halogen, haloalkyl, amino, alkylamino and dialkylamino; and alkyl substituted with one or two substituents each independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted aryl, optionally substituted arylalkyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo;
R30 and R31 are each independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl optionally substituted with one or two substituents independently selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted cycloalkyl, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted benzyl, optionally substituted heteroaryl, and optionally substituted heterocyclo; hydroxyalkyl optionally substituted at one or more carbon atoms with optionally substituted aryl or optionally substituted benzyl; aminoalkyl; dialkylaminoalkyl; diaminoalkyl; alkoxyalkyl; optionally substituted cycloalkyl; optionally substituted phenyl; optionally substituted benzyl; optionally substituted heteroaryl; and optionally substituted heterocyclo; A is O, -C(O)-, CH2, or absent, and B is CH or N; or A-B is CH=C;
D is -C(O)-, -CH=CH-, -NH-, -N(alkyl)-, or absent; m is 0, 1, 2 or 3; n is O, 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5; p is 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4; and q is 0, 1, 2, or 3; or at least one compound as set forth in any one of claims 1 to 72 in the production of a medicament for the modulation of calcium channels in a mammal.
89. The use of claim 88, wherein the N-type calcium channel is modulated.
PCT/EP2007/053053 2006-03-29 2007-03-29 Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use WO2007110449A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/225,743 US8247442B2 (en) 2006-03-29 2007-03-29 Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US78668806P 2006-03-29 2006-03-29
US60/786,688 2006-03-29
US79142806P 2006-04-13 2006-04-13
US60/791,428 2006-04-13

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2007110449A1 true WO2007110449A1 (en) 2007-10-04

Family

ID=38190623

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/EP2007/053053 WO2007110449A1 (en) 2006-03-29 2007-03-29 Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use

Country Status (2)

Country Link
US (1) US8247442B2 (en)
WO (1) WO2007110449A1 (en)

Cited By (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8093249B2 (en) 2008-07-17 2012-01-10 Convergence Pharmaceuticals Limited Pyrazolo[1,5-A]pyrimidine-carbonyl-piperazine derivatives
US8288388B2 (en) 2008-07-17 2012-10-16 Convergence Pharmaceuticals Limited 3-pyridylcarbonyl-piperazinylsulfonyl derivatives
WO2013001505A2 (en) 2011-06-29 2013-01-03 Adamed Sp. Z O.O. Sulphonamide derivatives of alicyclic amines for the treatment of central nervous system diseases
US8399486B2 (en) 2007-04-09 2013-03-19 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonyl compounds and the use thereof
US8518934B2 (en) 2008-06-11 2013-08-27 Shonogi & Co., Ltd. Oxycarbamoyl compounds and the use thereof
US8563732B2 (en) 2007-05-31 2013-10-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Oxyimino compounds and the use thereof
US8765736B2 (en) 2007-09-28 2014-07-01 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US8791264B2 (en) 2006-04-13 2014-07-29 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use as blockers of calcium channels
US8895551B2 (en) 2009-04-02 2014-11-25 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Acrylamide compounds and the use thereof
US8937181B2 (en) 2006-04-13 2015-01-20 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US9000174B2 (en) 2004-10-14 2015-04-07 Purdue Pharma L.P. 4-phenylsulfonamidopiperidines as calcium channel blockers

Families Citing this family (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
EP2676956A1 (en) * 2008-08-01 2013-12-25 Purdue Pharma L.P. Tetrahydropyridinyl and dihydropyrrolyl compounds and the use thereof

Citations (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB1445595A (en) * 1973-09-06 1976-08-11 Wyeth John & Brother Ltd 4-aminoquinoline derivatives and intermediates for their pre paration
WO1990015600A2 (en) * 1989-06-19 1990-12-27 A.H. Robins Company, Incorporated Treatment of chronic inflammatory joint disease with arylsulfonamides
US5028519A (en) * 1988-12-06 1991-07-02 Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. Silver halide color photosensitive material
WO1993022283A1 (en) * 1992-04-27 1993-11-11 Warner-Lambert Company Process for the manufacture of (s)-3-amino-1-substituted-pyrrolidines
WO1999001451A1 (en) * 1997-07-04 1999-01-14 Pfizer Limited Azetidinylpropylpiperidine derivatives, intermediates and use as tachykinin antagonists
WO2002028346A2 (en) * 2000-10-04 2002-04-11 Aventis Pharma S.A. Association of the cb1 receptor antagonist and sibutramin, for treating obesity
WO2004055006A1 (en) * 2002-12-17 2004-07-01 Astrazeneca Ab Novel compounds having selective inhibiting effect at gsk3
WO2004111014A1 (en) * 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Pyrimidine derivatives as modulators of atp-binding cassette transporters
US20050165065A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2005-07-28 Hassan Pajouhesh N-type calcium channel blockers
WO2005090296A2 (en) * 2004-03-11 2005-09-29 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. N-substituted benzene sulfonamides
WO2006105127A2 (en) * 2005-03-31 2006-10-05 Takeda San Diego, Inc. Hydroxysteroid dehydrogenase inhibitors
WO2007067617A2 (en) * 2005-12-08 2007-06-14 Aventis Pharmaceuticals Inc. Use of a cb1 antagonist for treating negative symptoms of schizophrenia

Family Cites Families (154)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB1482099A (en) * 1974-12-11 1977-08-03 Wyeth John & Brother Ltd Sulphonamido derivatives
US4131680A (en) 1974-12-11 1978-12-26 John Wyeth & Brother Ltd. Hypotensive sulphonamidopiperidyl indoles
DE2718405A1 (en) * 1977-04-26 1978-11-02 Boehringer Sohn Ingelheim NEW N-NECK CLAMP ON 1- (3-BENZOYLPROPYL) -4-PIPERIDYL NECK CLAMP ON -SULPHONIC ACID AMIDES AND METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF
IN148482B (en) 1977-06-03 1981-03-07 Pfizer
US5723490A (en) * 1992-09-08 1998-03-03 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated THF-containing sulfonamide inhibitors of aspartyl protease
US5739135A (en) * 1993-09-03 1998-04-14 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of microsomal triglyceride transfer protein and method
IL115420A0 (en) * 1994-09-26 1995-12-31 Zeneca Ltd Aminoheterocyclic derivatives
TW406075B (en) * 1994-12-13 2000-09-21 Upjohn Co Alkyl substituted piperidinyl and piperazinyl anti-AIDS compounds
US5688960A (en) 1995-05-02 1997-11-18 Schering Corporation Substituted oximes, hydrazones and olefins useful as neurokinin antagonists
US5696267A (en) 1995-05-02 1997-12-09 Schering Corporation Substituted oximes, hydrazones and olefins as neurokinin antagonists
DE69533991T2 (en) * 1995-05-29 2006-04-13 Pfizer Inc. DIPEPTIDES THAT STIMULATE THE DISTRIBUTION OF GROWTH HORMONES
CA2224517A1 (en) * 1995-06-12 1996-12-27 G.D. Searle & Co. Compositions comprising a cyclooxygenase-2 inhibitor and a 5-lipoxygenase inhibitor
PL185312B1 (en) 1995-10-05 2003-04-30 Darwin Discovery Ltd Thio-substituted peptides as inhibitors of metal proteinases and thf liberation
US6124341A (en) * 1996-02-13 2000-09-26 Abbott Laboratories Endothelin antagonists
US5827875A (en) * 1996-05-10 1998-10-27 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of microsomal triglyceride transfer protein and method
AU2898297A (en) 1996-05-24 1998-01-05 Novartis Ag Use of substance p antagonists for treating social phobia
US20020128476A1 (en) * 1996-08-08 2002-09-12 Smithkline Beecham Corporation Inhibitors of cysteine protease
US6281227B1 (en) * 1996-12-13 2001-08-28 Aventis Pharma Deutschland Gmbh Sulfonic acid sulfonylamino n-(heteroaralkyl)-azaheterocyclylamide compounds
US5972963A (en) * 1996-12-23 1999-10-26 Hoechst Marion Roussel, Inc. 3-aryl-2-(1-substituted 4-piperidinyl)-1,1-dioxo-3H-benzo[D]isothiazoles and related compounds
ZA98376B (en) 1997-01-23 1998-07-23 Hoffmann La Roche Sulfamide-metalloprotease inhibitors
US6376506B1 (en) * 1997-01-23 2002-04-23 Syntex (U.S.A.) Llc Sulfamide-metalloprotease inhibitors
US6136827A (en) * 1997-07-25 2000-10-24 Merck & Co., Inc. Cyclic amine modulations of chemokine receptor activity
AU9280698A (en) 1997-09-30 1999-04-23 Daiichi Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Sulfonyl derivatives
US6130220A (en) * 1997-10-16 2000-10-10 Syntex (Usa) Inc. Sulfamide-metalloprotease inhibitors
US6750228B1 (en) * 1997-11-14 2004-06-15 Pharmacia Corporation Aromatic sulfone hydroxamic acid metalloprotease inhibitor
UA59433C2 (en) * 1998-01-27 2003-09-15 Авентіс Фармасьютікалс Продактс Інк. Substituted oxoazaheterocyclyl inhibitors of xa factor
HUP0101048A2 (en) 1998-03-06 2001-10-28 Janssen Pharmaceutica N.V. Glycine transport inhibiting [4,4-bis(4-fluorophenyl)butyl]-1-(piperazinyl and piperidinyl) derivatives and their therapeutic use
GB9805520D0 (en) 1998-03-17 1998-05-13 Zeneca Ltd Chemical compounds
WO1999054284A1 (en) * 1998-04-20 1999-10-28 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Anthranilic acid derivatives as inhibitors of the cgmp-phosphodiesterase
US6303620B1 (en) * 1998-05-11 2001-10-16 Novo Nordisk A/S Compounds with growth hormone releasing properties
US6310059B1 (en) 1998-06-30 2001-10-30 Neuromed Technologies, Inc. Fused ring calcium channel blockers
US6387897B1 (en) * 1998-06-30 2002-05-14 Neuromed Technologies, Inc. Preferentially substituted calcium channel blockers
US6011035A (en) * 1998-06-30 2000-01-04 Neuromed Technologies Inc. Calcium channel blockers
US6492375B2 (en) * 1998-06-30 2002-12-10 Neuromed Technologies, Inc. Partially saturated calcium channel blockers
US6423519B1 (en) * 1998-07-15 2002-07-23 Gpc Biotech Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting fungal growth
US6316623B1 (en) 1998-08-21 2001-11-13 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Ethylenediamine compound libraries
KR100676109B1 (en) * 1998-10-16 2007-02-01 다이이치 아스비오파마 가부시키가이샤 Aminophenoxyacetic acid derivatives as neuroprotectants
US6267945B1 (en) 1998-12-18 2001-07-31 Neuromed Technologies, Inc. Farnesol-related calcium channel blockers
US6248739B1 (en) * 1999-01-08 2001-06-19 Pharmacia & Upjohn Company Quinolinecarboxamides as antiviral agents
AUPP818099A0 (en) * 1999-01-14 1999-02-11 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. New n-containing heterocyclic compounds
US6841552B1 (en) * 1999-05-05 2005-01-11 Ortho-Mcneil Pharmaceutical, Inc. 3a,4,5,9b-tetrahydro-1H-benz[e]indol-2-yl amine-derived neuropeptide Y receptors ligands useful in the treatment of obesity and other disorders
CA2372715A1 (en) 1999-05-13 2001-04-12 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Preventive or therapeutic drugs for diabetes
US6344358B1 (en) * 1999-05-28 2002-02-05 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Agent for expression of long-term potentiation of synaptic transmission comprising compound having brain somatostatin activation property
JP2003505435A (en) * 1999-06-04 2003-02-12 メルク エンド カムパニー インコーポレーテッド Substituted piperidines as melanocortin-4 receptor gonists
GB2352240A (en) 1999-07-13 2001-01-24 Lilly Co Eli Novel sulphonamides useful in treating CNS disorders
AR030676A1 (en) * 1999-07-28 2003-09-03 Ortho Mcneil Pharm Inc DERIVATIVES OF AMINAS AND AMIDAS AS LINKS TO THE NEUROPEPTIDE RECEIVER AND Y5 USEFUL IN THE TREATMENT OF OBESITY AND OTHER DISORDERS, USE OF THE SAME FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF PHARMACEUTICAL MEDICINES AND COMPOSITIONS THAT UNDERSTAND THEM
US20020151712A1 (en) 1999-09-14 2002-10-17 Nan-Horng Lin 3-pyrrolidinyloxy-3'-pyridyl ether compounds useful for controlling chemical synaptic transmission
AR025884A1 (en) * 1999-10-01 2002-12-18 Takeda Pharmaceutical CYCLINE AMINE COMPOUNDS, ITS PRODUCTION AND USE
DK2014285T3 (en) * 1999-11-26 2010-06-28 Shionogi & Co NPYY5 receptor antagonists
FR2802206B1 (en) * 1999-12-14 2005-04-22 Sod Conseils Rech Applic 4-AMINOPIPERIDINE DERIVATIVES AND THEIR USE AS MEDICINAL PRODUCTS
US6797820B2 (en) * 1999-12-17 2004-09-28 Vicuron Pharmaceuticals Inc. Succinate compounds, compositions and methods of use and preparation
WO2001044179A1 (en) 1999-12-17 2001-06-21 Versicor, Inc. Novel succinate compounds, compositions and methods of use and preparation
FR2804429B1 (en) 2000-01-31 2003-05-09 Adir NOVEL 4-SULFONAMIDE PIPERIDINE DERIVATIVES, PROCESS FOR PREPARING THEM AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING SAME
KR20020069362A (en) 2000-01-20 2002-08-30 에자이 가부시키가이샤 Nitrogenous cyclic compounds and pharmaceutical compositions containing the same
US6566356B2 (en) * 2000-03-03 2003-05-20 Aventis Pharma S.A. Pharmaceutical compositions containing 3-aminoazetidine derivatives, novel derivatives and their preparation
US6355631B1 (en) * 2000-03-03 2002-03-12 Aventis Pharma S.A. Pharmaceutical compositions containing azetidine derivatives, novel azetidine derivatives and their preparation
WO2001070708A1 (en) 2000-03-23 2001-09-27 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted piperidines as melanocortin receptor agonists
US20030176461A1 (en) * 2000-04-20 2003-09-18 Egle Ian R. Aminopiperidines
JP2001322977A (en) 2000-05-12 2001-11-20 Kotobuki Seiyaku Kk Pipecolic acid derivative and method for producing the same and pharmaceutical composition containing the same
US6683093B2 (en) * 2000-05-12 2004-01-27 Pharmacia Corporation Aromatic sulfone hydroxamic acids and their use as protease inhibitors
GB0011838D0 (en) * 2000-05-17 2000-07-05 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical compounds
EP1162194A1 (en) * 2000-06-06 2001-12-12 Aventis Pharma Deutschland GmbH Factor VIIa inhibitory (thio)urea derivatives, their preparation and their use
HUP0301802A3 (en) * 2000-06-28 2009-04-28 Teva Pharma Process for producing carvedilol, crystalline carvedilol, process for producing it and pharmaceutical composition containing it
JP2004504397A (en) 2000-07-26 2004-02-12 スミスクライン ビーチャム パブリック リミテッド カンパニー Aminopiperidinequinolines with antibacterial activity and their azaisosteric analogs
US20020055457A1 (en) * 2000-08-07 2002-05-09 Janus Todd J. Methods of treating cancer and the pain associated therewith using endothelin antagonists
US20020165223A1 (en) 2000-09-14 2002-11-07 Greenlee William J. Substituted urea neuropeptide Y Y5 receptor antagonists
US6894063B2 (en) * 2000-09-14 2005-05-17 Schering Corporation Substituted urea neuropeptide Y Y5 Receptor antagonists
AU2001291830A1 (en) * 2000-09-25 2002-04-02 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Substituted amino-aza-cycloalkanes useful against malaria
US20020091114A1 (en) * 2000-10-04 2002-07-11 Odile Piot-Grosjean Combination of a CB1 receptor antagonist and of sibutramine, the pharmaceutical compositions comprising them and their use in the treatment of obesity
US20020094989A1 (en) * 2000-10-11 2002-07-18 Hale Jeffrey J. Pyrrolidine modulators of CCR5 chemokine receptor activity
DE10058461A1 (en) 2000-11-24 2002-09-19 Bayer Ag Substituted cyclohexane derivatives and their use
ES2316486T3 (en) 2000-12-21 2009-04-16 Schering Corporation ANTAGONSITAS OF THE Y5 RECEPTORS OF THE NEUROPEPTIDE AND HETEROARIL-UREA.
US6946476B2 (en) * 2000-12-21 2005-09-20 Schering Corporation Heteroaryl urea neuropeptide Y Y5 receptor antagonists
GB0101577D0 (en) * 2001-01-22 2001-03-07 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
SK286917B6 (en) 2001-02-28 2009-07-06 Merck & Co., Inc. 4-Substituted N-acylated piperidine derivatives, pharmaceutical composition containing thereof and their use
JP2004520423A (en) 2001-03-01 2004-07-08 アストラゼネカ・アクチエボラーグ N-piperidinyl compounds as CCR5 modulators
JP2005511475A (en) * 2001-03-02 2005-04-28 ブリストル−マイヤーズ スクイブ カンパニー Compounds useful as modulators of melanocortin receptors and pharmaceutical compositions containing the same
US20040152692A1 (en) * 2001-03-29 2004-08-05 Dashyant Dhanak Pyrrolidine sulfonamides
WO2002100399A1 (en) * 2001-06-12 2002-12-19 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Macrocycles useful in the treatment of alzheimer's disease
ATE374181T1 (en) 2001-06-27 2007-10-15 Smithkline Beecham Corp FLUORPYRROLIDINES AS DIPEPTIDYLPEPTIDASE INHIBITORS
US6667319B2 (en) 2001-07-26 2003-12-23 Schering-Plough Corporation Neuropeptide Y Y5 receptor antagonists
MXPA04001016A (en) 2001-08-03 2004-05-27 Schering Corp Sulfonamide derivatives as gamma secretase inhibitors.
JP2003081937A (en) 2001-09-07 2003-03-19 Bayer Ag Benzenesulfonamide derivative
WO2003024451A1 (en) * 2001-09-08 2003-03-27 Boehringer Ingelheim Pharma Gmbh & Co. Kg 2-(2-phenylethyl)-benzimidazole-5-carboxamide derivatives and their use as tryptase inhibitors
WO2003024456A1 (en) 2001-09-20 2003-03-27 Eisai Co., Ltd. Methods for treating and preventing migraines
CA2460594A1 (en) * 2001-10-01 2003-04-10 Taisho Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Mch receptor antagonists
HUP0401656A3 (en) * 2001-10-25 2012-05-02 Schering Corp Mch antagonists for the treatment of obesity and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
CA2467857C (en) 2001-11-26 2010-08-24 Duane A. Burnett Piperidine-based mch antagonists for treatment of obesity and cns disorders
EP2316470A3 (en) 2001-11-26 2011-08-24 Trustees Of Tufts College Peptidomimetic inhibitors of post-proline cleaving enzymes
IL162851A0 (en) * 2001-12-04 2005-11-20 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 4-(Piperidyl-and pyrrolidyl-alkyl-ureido)-quinolines as urotensin ii receptor antagonists
WO2003049736A1 (en) 2001-12-11 2003-06-19 Sepracor, Inc. 4-substituted piperidines, and methods of use thereof
GB0130261D0 (en) 2001-12-18 2002-02-06 Pfizer Ltd Lactams as tachykinin antagonists
CN101973998A (en) 2001-12-20 2011-02-16 Osi药物公司 Pyrrolopyrimidine A2b selective antagonist compounds, their synthesis and use
WO2003059265A2 (en) 2001-12-21 2003-07-24 Cytokinetics, Inc. Compositions and methods for treating heart failure
US6995144B2 (en) * 2002-03-14 2006-02-07 Eisai Co., Ltd. Nitrogen containing heterocyclic compounds and medicines containing the same
US20050208044A1 (en) 2002-03-19 2005-09-22 Jane Barclay Methods for the identification of compounds useful for the suppression of chronic neuropathic pain and compositions thereof
WO2003084542A1 (en) 2002-04-10 2003-10-16 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Neurotrophic factor production accelerator
DE10217006A1 (en) * 2002-04-16 2003-11-06 Merck Patent Gmbh Substituted indoles
AR040336A1 (en) * 2002-06-26 2005-03-30 Glaxo Group Ltd PIPERIDINE COMPOUND, USE OF THE SAME FOR THE MANUFACTURE OF A MEDICINAL PRODUCT, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION THAT INCLUDES IT AND PROCEDURE TO PREPARE SUCH COMPOUND
CN100374440C (en) * 2002-06-27 2008-03-12 先灵公司 Spirosubstituted piperidines as selective melanin concentrating hormone receptor antagonists for the treatment of obesity
WO2004009549A2 (en) 2002-07-18 2004-01-29 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Piperidines useful for the treatment of central nervous system disorders
TW200401635A (en) * 2002-07-23 2004-02-01 Yamanouchi Pharma Co Ltd 2-Cyano-4-fluoropyrrolidine derivative or salt thereof
US20040067947A1 (en) * 2002-08-30 2004-04-08 Wathen Michael W Method of preventing or treating atherosclerosis or restenosis
ATE496884T1 (en) * 2002-10-11 2011-02-15 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd SULPHONYLAMINOACETIC ACID DERIVATIVES AND THEIR USE AS OREXIN RECEPTOR ANTAGONISTS
WO2004058709A1 (en) 2002-12-23 2004-07-15 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Ccr8 inhibitors
US7491827B2 (en) * 2002-12-23 2009-02-17 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Aryl sulfonamides useful as inhibitors of chemokine receptor activity
TW200510311A (en) 2002-12-23 2005-03-16 Millennium Pharm Inc CCr8 inhibitors
TW200505834A (en) 2003-03-18 2005-02-16 Sankyo Co Sulfamide derivative and the pharmaceutical composition thereof
TW200505902A (en) * 2003-03-20 2005-02-16 Schering Corp Cannabinoid receptor ligands
WO2004091485A2 (en) * 2003-04-11 2004-10-28 Taigen Biotechnology Aminoquinoline compounds
US7049323B2 (en) 2003-04-25 2006-05-23 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Amidoheterocycles as modulators of the melanocortin-4 receptor
CN1226059C (en) 2003-05-21 2005-11-09 江西洪达医疗器械集团有限公司 Self-destructible safe syringe
US7405210B2 (en) * 2003-05-21 2008-07-29 Osi Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pyrrolopyridine-2-carboxylic acid amide inhibitors of glycogen phosphorylase
WO2004105750A1 (en) 2003-05-30 2004-12-09 Neuromed Technologies, Inc. 3-aminomethyl-pyrrolidines as n-type calcium channel blockers
GB0314054D0 (en) * 2003-06-17 2003-07-23 Pfizer Ltd Amide derivatives as selective serotonin re-uptake inhibitors
GB0317315D0 (en) 2003-07-24 2003-08-27 Astex Technology Ltd Pharmaceutical compounds
US7449482B2 (en) 2003-08-01 2008-11-11 Chugai Seiyaku Kabushiki Kaisha Piperidine compounds useful as malonyl-CoA decarboxylase inhibitors
AU2004276337B2 (en) * 2003-09-24 2009-11-12 Methylgene Inc. Inhibitors of histone deacetylase
US7317025B2 (en) * 2003-09-24 2008-01-08 Johnson & Johnson Pharmaceutical Research & Development, Llc Non-peptidic NPY Y2 receptor inhibitors
CA2540196C (en) * 2003-09-26 2012-03-20 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Pyridine derivatives and use thereof as urotensin ii antagonists
US20050119266A1 (en) * 2003-10-01 2005-06-02 Yan Shi Pyrrolidine and piperidine derivatives as factor Xa inhibitors
GB0325956D0 (en) 2003-11-06 2003-12-10 Addex Pharmaceuticals Sa Novel compounds
GB0326546D0 (en) * 2003-11-14 2003-12-17 Amersham Plc Inhibitor imaging agents
JP2005154380A (en) 2003-11-28 2005-06-16 Tanabe Seiyaku Co Ltd Piperidine derivative
JP4380508B2 (en) 2003-11-28 2009-12-09 田辺三菱製薬株式会社 Pharmaceutical composition
TW200530226A (en) * 2003-12-03 2005-09-16 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel M3 muscarinic acetylcholine receptor antagonists
WO2005066145A1 (en) 2004-01-06 2005-07-21 Novo Nordisk A/S Heteroaryl-ureas and their use as glucokinase activators
US20050197336A1 (en) * 2004-03-08 2005-09-08 Miikana Therapeutics Corporation Inhibitors of histone deacetylase
DE102004012070A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-29 Boehringer Ingelheim Pharma Gmbh & Co. Kg New cycloalkyl-containing 5-acylindolinones, their preparation and their use as medicaments
US7217702B2 (en) 2004-04-02 2007-05-15 Adenosine Therapeutics, Llc Selective antagonists of A2A adenosine receptors
BRPI0509573A (en) 2004-04-02 2007-09-25 Novartis Ag sulfonamide thiazolpyridine derivatives as useful glucokinase activators for the treatment of type 2 diabetes
CN1976931A (en) * 2004-04-09 2007-06-06 千禧药品公司 Beta-carbolines useful for treating inflammatory disease
EP1745042A4 (en) 2004-04-09 2010-07-14 Neuromed Pharmaceuticals Ltd Diarylamine derivatives as calcium channel blockers
US7880001B2 (en) 2004-04-29 2011-02-01 Abbott Laboratories Inhibitors of the 11-beta-hydroxysteroid dehydrogenase Type 1 enzyme
CN101035525A (en) * 2004-06-17 2007-09-12 赛特凯恩蒂克公司 Substituted urea derivatives for treating cardiac diseases
WO2006001318A1 (en) * 2004-06-24 2006-01-05 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Sulfonamide compound
WO2006029154A2 (en) 2004-09-07 2006-03-16 Smithkline Beecham Corporation Novel compounds
KR20070106969A (en) 2004-09-09 2007-11-06 추가이 세이야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Novel imidazolidine derivative and use thereof
GB0420424D0 (en) 2004-09-14 2004-10-20 Ionix Pharmaceuticals Ltd Therapeutic compounds
TW200630337A (en) * 2004-10-14 2006-09-01 Euro Celtique Sa Piperidinyl compounds and the use thereof
TWI360539B (en) * 2004-10-28 2012-03-21 Shionogi & Co 3-carbamoyl-2-pyridone derivatives
EP1702916A1 (en) 2005-03-18 2006-09-20 Santhera Pharmaceuticals (Schweiz) GmbH DPP-IV inhibitors
EP1863490A2 (en) * 2005-03-28 2007-12-12 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Muscarinic modulators
WO2006134481A1 (en) 2005-06-16 2006-12-21 Pfizer Inc. Inhibitors of 11-beta hydroxysteroid dehydrogenase type 1
JP2009500340A (en) * 2005-06-29 2009-01-08 メルク エンド カムパニー インコーポレーテッド 4-Fluoro-piperidine T-type calcium channel antagonist
WO2007052843A1 (en) 2005-11-04 2007-05-10 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Heterocyclic amide compound and use thereof
EP1965799A2 (en) * 2005-12-22 2008-09-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted piperidines as calcium channel blockers
US8791264B2 (en) * 2006-04-13 2014-07-29 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use as blockers of calcium channels
WO2007118854A1 (en) 2006-04-13 2007-10-25 Euro-Celtique S.A. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
EP2079695A2 (en) 2006-10-20 2009-07-22 Arete Therapeutics, INC. Phenylurea compounds as soluble epoxide hydrolase inhibitors
WO2008050200A1 (en) 2006-10-24 2008-05-02 Pfizer Products Inc. Oxadiazole compounds as calcium channel antagonists
CL2007003223A1 (en) 2006-11-10 2008-01-11 Wyeth Corp Compounds derived from n-substituted piperidinyl 4-arylsulfonamides, which act as modulators of the sfrp-1 protein; process to prepare the compounds; pharmaceutical composition comprising said co-compounds and use of the compounds to prepare medicaments for the treatment of diseases.
WO2008124118A1 (en) 2007-04-09 2008-10-16 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonyl compounds and the use therof
WO2009040659A2 (en) 2007-09-28 2009-04-02 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof

Patent Citations (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB1445595A (en) * 1973-09-06 1976-08-11 Wyeth John & Brother Ltd 4-aminoquinoline derivatives and intermediates for their pre paration
US5028519A (en) * 1988-12-06 1991-07-02 Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. Silver halide color photosensitive material
WO1990015600A2 (en) * 1989-06-19 1990-12-27 A.H. Robins Company, Incorporated Treatment of chronic inflammatory joint disease with arylsulfonamides
WO1993022283A1 (en) * 1992-04-27 1993-11-11 Warner-Lambert Company Process for the manufacture of (s)-3-amino-1-substituted-pyrrolidines
WO1999001451A1 (en) * 1997-07-04 1999-01-14 Pfizer Limited Azetidinylpropylpiperidine derivatives, intermediates and use as tachykinin antagonists
WO2002028346A2 (en) * 2000-10-04 2002-04-11 Aventis Pharma S.A. Association of the cb1 receptor antagonist and sibutramin, for treating obesity
WO2004055006A1 (en) * 2002-12-17 2004-07-01 Astrazeneca Ab Novel compounds having selective inhibiting effect at gsk3
WO2004111014A1 (en) * 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Pyrimidine derivatives as modulators of atp-binding cassette transporters
US20050165065A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2005-07-28 Hassan Pajouhesh N-type calcium channel blockers
WO2005090296A2 (en) * 2004-03-11 2005-09-29 Elan Pharmaceuticals, Inc. N-substituted benzene sulfonamides
WO2006105127A2 (en) * 2005-03-31 2006-10-05 Takeda San Diego, Inc. Hydroxysteroid dehydrogenase inhibitors
WO2007067617A2 (en) * 2005-12-08 2007-06-14 Aventis Pharmaceuticals Inc. Use of a cb1 antagonist for treating negative symptoms of schizophrenia

Non-Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
CAULFIELD W L ET AL: "The first potent and selective Inhibitors of the Glycine Transporter Type 2", JOURNAL OF MEDICINAL CHEMISTRY, AMERICAN CHEMICAL SOCIETY. WASHINGTON, US, vol. 44, no. 17, 16 August 2001 (2001-08-16), pages 2679 - 2682, XP002183670, ISSN: 0022-2623 *
KARIKOMI M ET AL: "A novel synthesis of 3-aminoazetidines by ring transformation of 2-(bromomethyl)aziridines", TETRAHEDRON LETTERS, ELSEVIER, AMSTERDAM, NL, vol. 41, no. 52, 23 December 2000 (2000-12-23), pages 10295 - 10298, XP004225177, ISSN: 0040-4039 *

Cited By (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9000174B2 (en) 2004-10-14 2015-04-07 Purdue Pharma L.P. 4-phenylsulfonamidopiperidines as calcium channel blockers
US8791264B2 (en) 2006-04-13 2014-07-29 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use as blockers of calcium channels
US8937181B2 (en) 2006-04-13 2015-01-20 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US8399486B2 (en) 2007-04-09 2013-03-19 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonyl compounds and the use thereof
US8563732B2 (en) 2007-05-31 2013-10-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Oxyimino compounds and the use thereof
US8765736B2 (en) 2007-09-28 2014-07-01 Purdue Pharma L.P. Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US8518934B2 (en) 2008-06-11 2013-08-27 Shonogi & Co., Ltd. Oxycarbamoyl compounds and the use thereof
US8093249B2 (en) 2008-07-17 2012-01-10 Convergence Pharmaceuticals Limited Pyrazolo[1,5-A]pyrimidine-carbonyl-piperazine derivatives
US8288388B2 (en) 2008-07-17 2012-10-16 Convergence Pharmaceuticals Limited 3-pyridylcarbonyl-piperazinylsulfonyl derivatives
US8895551B2 (en) 2009-04-02 2014-11-25 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Acrylamide compounds and the use thereof
WO2013001505A2 (en) 2011-06-29 2013-01-03 Adamed Sp. Z O.O. Sulphonamide derivatives of alicyclic amines for the treatment of central nervous system diseases

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20090239910A1 (en) 2009-09-24
US8247442B2 (en) 2012-08-21

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8247442B2 (en) Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use
US8791264B2 (en) Benzenesulfonamide compounds and their use as blockers of calcium channels
US8883816B2 (en) Fused and spirocycle compounds and the use thereof
US8937181B2 (en) Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US8765736B2 (en) Benzenesulfonamide compounds and the use thereof
US8399486B2 (en) Benzenesulfonyl compounds and the use thereof
EP2331522B1 (en) Tetrahydropyridinyl and dihydropyrrolyl compounds and the use thereof
EP2164325B1 (en) Oxyimino compounds and the use thereof
EP2346820B1 (en) Oxycarbamoyl compounds and the use thereof
US20110190300A1 (en) Amide compounds and the use thereof
US20120322830A1 (en) Cyclourea Compounds as Calcium Channel Blockers
EP2414332B1 (en) Acrylamide compounds and the use thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 07727525

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

DPE1 Request for preliminary examination filed after expiration of 19th month from priority date (pct application filed from 20040101)
NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 12225743

Country of ref document: US

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 07727525

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1